EP4105644A2 - Systems and devices for sequence by synthesis analysis - Google Patents

Systems and devices for sequence by synthesis analysis Download PDF

Info

Publication number
EP4105644A2
EP4105644A2 EP22177074.6A EP22177074A EP4105644A2 EP 4105644 A2 EP4105644 A2 EP 4105644A2 EP 22177074 A EP22177074 A EP 22177074A EP 4105644 A2 EP4105644 A2 EP 4105644A2
Authority
EP
European Patent Office
Prior art keywords
flowcell
flowcells
optionally
laser
illumination
Prior art date
Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
Pending
Application number
EP22177074.6A
Other languages
German (de)
French (fr)
Other versions
EP4105644A3 (en
Inventor
Saibal Banerjee
Colin Barnes
Kevin Benson
John RIDGHAM
Jason Bryant
Dale Buermann
Sergey Etchin
Jonny Ho
Xavier Lee
Peter Lundberg
Klaus Maisinger
Bojan Obradovic
Mark Pratt
Isabelle Rasolonjatovo
Mark Reed
Chiara Rodighiero
Subra Sankar
Gary Schroth
Harold Swerdlow
Eric Vermaas
Ning Sizto
Current Assignee (The listed assignees may be inaccurate. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of the list.)
Illumina Inc
Original Assignee
Illumina Inc
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by Illumina Inc filed Critical Illumina Inc
Publication of EP4105644A2 publication Critical patent/EP4105644A2/en
Publication of EP4105644A3 publication Critical patent/EP4105644A3/en
Pending legal-status Critical Current

Links

Images

Classifications

    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12QMEASURING OR TESTING PROCESSES INVOLVING ENZYMES, NUCLEIC ACIDS OR MICROORGANISMS; COMPOSITIONS OR TEST PAPERS THEREFOR; PROCESSES OF PREPARING SUCH COMPOSITIONS; CONDITION-RESPONSIVE CONTROL IN MICROBIOLOGICAL OR ENZYMOLOGICAL PROCESSES
    • C12Q1/00Measuring or testing processes involving enzymes, nucleic acids or microorganisms; Compositions therefor; Processes of preparing such compositions
    • C12Q1/68Measuring or testing processes involving enzymes, nucleic acids or microorganisms; Compositions therefor; Processes of preparing such compositions involving nucleic acids
    • C12Q1/6869Methods for sequencing
    • BPERFORMING OPERATIONS; TRANSPORTING
    • B01PHYSICAL OR CHEMICAL PROCESSES OR APPARATUS IN GENERAL
    • B01LCHEMICAL OR PHYSICAL LABORATORY APPARATUS FOR GENERAL USE
    • B01L3/00Containers or dishes for laboratory use, e.g. laboratory glassware; Droppers
    • B01L3/50Containers for the purpose of retaining a material to be analysed, e.g. test tubes
    • B01L3/502Containers for the purpose of retaining a material to be analysed, e.g. test tubes with fluid transport, e.g. in multi-compartment structures
    • B01L3/5027Containers for the purpose of retaining a material to be analysed, e.g. test tubes with fluid transport, e.g. in multi-compartment structures by integrated microfluidic structures, i.e. dimensions of channels and chambers are such that surface tension forces are important, e.g. lab-on-a-chip
    • B01L3/502715Containers for the purpose of retaining a material to be analysed, e.g. test tubes with fluid transport, e.g. in multi-compartment structures by integrated microfluidic structures, i.e. dimensions of channels and chambers are such that surface tension forces are important, e.g. lab-on-a-chip characterised by interfacing components, e.g. fluidic, electrical, optical or mechanical interfaces
    • BPERFORMING OPERATIONS; TRANSPORTING
    • B01PHYSICAL OR CHEMICAL PROCESSES OR APPARATUS IN GENERAL
    • B01LCHEMICAL OR PHYSICAL LABORATORY APPARATUS FOR GENERAL USE
    • B01L9/00Supporting devices; Holding devices
    • B01L9/52Supports specially adapted for flat sample carriers, e.g. for plates, slides, chips
    • B01L9/527Supports specially adapted for flat sample carriers, e.g. for plates, slides, chips for microfluidic devices, e.g. used for lab-on-a-chip
    • GPHYSICS
    • G01MEASURING; TESTING
    • G01NINVESTIGATING OR ANALYSING MATERIALS BY DETERMINING THEIR CHEMICAL OR PHYSICAL PROPERTIES
    • G01N21/00Investigating or analysing materials by the use of optical means, i.e. using sub-millimetre waves, infrared, visible or ultraviolet light
    • G01N21/62Systems in which the material investigated is excited whereby it emits light or causes a change in wavelength of the incident light
    • G01N21/63Systems in which the material investigated is excited whereby it emits light or causes a change in wavelength of the incident light optically excited
    • G01N21/64Fluorescence; Phosphorescence
    • G01N21/645Specially adapted constructive features of fluorimeters
    • G01N21/6456Spatial resolved fluorescence measurements; Imaging
    • BPERFORMING OPERATIONS; TRANSPORTING
    • B01PHYSICAL OR CHEMICAL PROCESSES OR APPARATUS IN GENERAL
    • B01LCHEMICAL OR PHYSICAL LABORATORY APPARATUS FOR GENERAL USE
    • B01L2300/00Additional constructional details
    • B01L2300/08Geometry, shape and general structure
    • B01L2300/0861Configuration of multiple channels and/or chambers in a single devices
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12QMEASURING OR TESTING PROCESSES INVOLVING ENZYMES, NUCLEIC ACIDS OR MICROORGANISMS; COMPOSITIONS OR TEST PAPERS THEREFOR; PROCESSES OF PREPARING SUCH COMPOSITIONS; CONDITION-RESPONSIVE CONTROL IN MICROBIOLOGICAL OR ENZYMOLOGICAL PROCESSES
    • C12Q2535/00Reactions characterised by the assay type for determining the identity of a nucleotide base or a sequence of oligonucleotides
    • C12Q2535/122Massive parallel sequencing
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12QMEASURING OR TESTING PROCESSES INVOLVING ENZYMES, NUCLEIC ACIDS OR MICROORGANISMS; COMPOSITIONS OR TEST PAPERS THEREFOR; PROCESSES OF PREPARING SUCH COMPOSITIONS; CONDITION-RESPONSIVE CONTROL IN MICROBIOLOGICAL OR ENZYMOLOGICAL PROCESSES
    • C12Q2565/00Nucleic acid analysis characterised by mode or means of detection
    • C12Q2565/60Detection means characterised by use of a special device

Definitions

  • the current invention relates to the field of nucleic acid sequencing. More specifically, the present invention provides systems and devices for sequence analysis of nucleic acids such as short DNA sequences from clonally amplified single-molecule arrays.
  • the Human Genome Project has determined the entire sequence of the human genome which is hoped to lead to further discoveries in fields ranging from treatment of disease to advances in basic science. While the "human genome” has been sequenced there are still vast amounts of genomic material to analyze, e.g., genetic variation between different individuals, tissues, additional species, etc.
  • the methodology used to analyze the sequence of the nucleic acids in such new sequencing techniques is often based on the detection of fluorescent nucleotides or oligonucleotides.
  • the detection instrumentation used to read the fluorescence signals on such arrays is usually based on either epifluorescence or total internal reflection microscopy, for example as described in WO9641011 , WO00006770 or WO02072892 . Whilst total internal reflection microscopy has been used to image both single and amplified molecules of DNA on surfaces, a robust, reliable, four color DNA sequencing platform (e.g., comprising heating systems, fluidic controls, uniform illumination, control of the optical beam shape, an autofocus system, and full software control of all components) is described herein for the first time.
  • the invention comprises systems and devices for sequencing one or more polynucleotide.
  • the systems can be used to image planar substrates, wherein the substrates can comprise unamplified single molecules, amplified single molecules, one or more collections of arrayed beads, or various combinations thereof.
  • the systems can optionally comprise a planar solid substrate having one or more polynucleotides displayed thereon, e.g.
  • a fluid direction system that controllably moves various reagents (e.g., buffers, enzymes, fluorescently labeled nucleotides or oligonucleotides, etc.) into contact with the polynucleotides; a temperature control system that regulates the temperature of the substrate and/or of the reagents; an optical system for obtaining total internal reflection illumination of the substrate with a uniform beam footprint (where the shape of the footprint is optionally controlled), a light source (e.g., one comprising one or more lasers) for exciting the fluorescent moiet(ies); a detector component (e.g., a CCD camera and objective lenses, etc.) that is proximal to the substrate and which captures and detects fluorescence from the excited moiet(ies); a computer, connected to the detector, which has instruction sets for controlling the various components of the system, acquiring fluorescence data from the detector and optionally for determining sequence of the poly
  • the substrates can be moved away from the detector in order to interact with the temperature control system, thus, regulating the temperature of the substrate (e.g., to allow polymerase reactions to proceed, etc.).
  • the system can comprise a scanning stage or moving platform that is optionally computer controlled.
  • the heating device can be a computer controlled Peltier device or other heating/cooling component that moves in relation to the scanning stage, or the stage can optionally move to ensure that the Peltier is in contact with the substrate.
  • the substrate can comprise a flowcell.
  • Flowcells can have one or more fluidic channel in which the polynucleotide is displayed (e.g., wherein the polynucleotides are directly attached to the flowcell or wherein the polynucleotides are attached to one or more beads arrayed upon the flowcell) and can be comprised of glass, silicon, plastic, or various combinations thereof.
  • the reagents include components to synthesize a second sequence complementary to the one or more polynucleotides.
  • the synthesis can be performed using labeled nucleotides, which can be added individually or as a mixture of nucleotides, or as labeled oligonucleotides.
  • labeled oligonucleotides the identity of one or more bases complementary to the labeled oligonucleotide can be determined.
  • the labeled nucleotides can take the form of fluorescently labeled triphosphates, which can contain a blocking moiety to control the addition and ensure a single nucleotide is added to each polynucleotide.
  • the fluorophore can be attached to the blocking moiety, which can be located at the 3' position of the sugar, or can be attached through the nucleotide base through a linker that can optionally be cleaved using the same conditions as removal of the blocking moiety.
  • the linker and blocking moiety may be cleaved using the same reagents.
  • the Total Internal Reflection (TIRF) system can comprise, e.g., a lamp or a laser.
  • the system can comprise more than one excitation lasers that can be coupled through a fiberoptic device. Such lasers can illuminate at least part of the same area. (i.e., overlap).
  • the TIRF lasers herein also optionally comprise a shaking, vibrating, waveplate modulated, or piezo-electric actuator squeezed fiber mode scrambler to make the optical intensity substantially uniform over an entire illumination footprint of the laser. A number of mechanisms for controlling the illumination intensity and uniformity are described herein.
  • the shape of the fiber also can be used to control the shape of the illumination footprint.
  • the detector component in the various embodiments herein can comprise one or more objective lenses, additional tube lenses, an autofocus system that adjusts either the stage position and/or the position of the objective lens(es) to ensure the substrate remains in focus, optical filter(s) appropriate to transmit the emission wavelength of the fluorophores and block the light from the excitation source, and a system for recording the fluorescence emission from the fluorophores, for example a charge coupled device (CCD) or similar camera.
  • CCD charge coupled device
  • the present invention comprises systems and devices to analyze a large number of different nucleic acid sequences from, e.g., clonally amplified single-molecule DNA arrays in flowcells, or from an array of immobilized beads.
  • the systems herein are optionally useful in, e.g., sequencing for comparative genomics (such as for genotyping, SNP discovery, BAC-end sequencing, chromosome breakpoint mapping, and whole genome sequence assembly), tracking gene expression, micro RNA sequence analysis, epigenomics (e.g., with methylation mapping DNAsel hypersensitive site mapping or chromatin immunoprecipitation), and aptamer and phage display library characterization.
  • fluid delivery module or device 100 directs the flow of reagents (e.g., fluorescent nucleotides, buffers, enzymes, cleavage reagents, etc.) to (and through) flowcell 110 and waste valve 120.
  • the flowcell comprises clusters of nucleic acid sequences (e.g., of about 200-1000 bases in length) to be sequenced which are optionally attached to the substrate of the flowcell, as well as optionally other components.
  • the flowcell can also comprise an array of beads, where each bead optionally contains multiple copies of a single sequence. The preparation of such beads can be performed according to a variety of techniques, for example as described in USPN 6,172,218 or WO04069849 (Bead emulsion nucleic acid amplification).
  • the system also comprises temperature station actuator 130 and heater/cooler 135, which can optionally regulate the temperature of conditions of the fluids within the flowcell.
  • various embodiments can comprise different configurations of the heating/cooling components.
  • the flowcell is monitored, and sequencing is tracked, by camera system 140 (e.g., a CCD camera) which can interact with various filters within filter switching assembly 145, lens objective 142, and focusing laser/focusing laser assembly 150.
  • Laser device 160 e.g., an excitation laser within an assembly optionally comprising multiple lasers
  • Low watt lamp 165, mirror 180 and reverse dichroic 185 are also presented in the embodiment shown. See below.
  • mounting stage 170 allows for proper alignment and movement of the flowcell, temperature actuator, camera, etc. in relation to the various components of the invention.
  • Focus (z-axis) component 175 can also aid in manipulation and positioning of various components (e.g., a lens objective).
  • Such components are optionally organized upon a framework and/or enclosed within a housing structure.
  • the illustrations herein are of exemplary embodiments and are not necessarily to be taken as limiting.
  • different embodiments can comprise different placement of components relative to one another (e.g., embodiment A comprises a heater/cooler as in Figure 1 , while embodiment B comprises a heater/cooler component beneath its flowcell, etc.).
  • polynucleotide or “nucleic acids” refer to deoxyribonucleic acid (DNA), but where appropriate the skilled artisan will recognize that the systems and devices herein can also be utilized with ribonucleic acid (RNA).
  • RNA ribonucleic acid
  • the terms should be understood to include, as equivalents, analogs of either DNA or RNA made from nucleotide analogs.
  • the terms as used herein also encompasses cDNA, that is complementary, or copy, DNA produced from an RNA template, for example by the action of reverse transcriptase.
  • the single stranded polynucleotide molecules sequenced by the systems and devices herein can have originated in single-stranded form, as DNA or RNA or have originated in double-stranded DNA (dsDNA) form (e.g. genomic DNA fragments, PCR and amplification products and the like).
  • dsDNA double-stranded DNA
  • a single stranded polynucleotide may be the sense or antisense strand of a polynucleotide duplex.
  • Methods of preparation of single stranded polynucleotide molecules suitable for use in the method of the invention using standard techniques are well known in the art.
  • the precise sequence of the primary polynucleotide molecules is generally not material to the invention, and may be known or unknown.
  • the single stranded polynucleotide molecules can represent genomic DNA molecules (e.g., human genomic DNA) including both intron and exon sequences (coding sequence), as well as non-coding regulatory sequences such as promoter
  • the nucleic acid to be sequenced through use of the current invention is immobilized upon a substrate (e.g., a substrate within a flowcell or one or more beads upon a substrate such as a flowcell, etc.).
  • a substrate e.g., a substrate within a flowcell or one or more beads upon a substrate such as a flowcell, etc.
  • immobilized as used herein is intended to encompass direct or indirect, covalent or non-covalent attachment, unless indicated otherwise, either explicitly or by context.
  • covalent attachment may be preferred, but generally all that is required is that the molecules (e.g. nucleic acids) remain immobilized or attached to the support under conditions in which it is intended to use the support, for example in applications requiring nucleic acid sequencing.
  • solid support refers to any inert substrate or matrix to which nucleic acids can be attached, such as for example glass surfaces, plastic surfaces, latex, dextran, polystyrene surfaces, polypropylene surfaces, polyacrylamide gels, gold surfaces, and silicon wafers.
  • the solid support is a glass surface (e.g., the planar surface of a flowcell channel).
  • the solid support may comprise an inert substrate or matrix which has been "functionalized,” for example by the application of a layer or coating of an intermediate material comprising reactive groups which permit covalent attachment to molecules such as polynucleotides.
  • such supports can include polyacrylamide hydrogels supported on an inert substrate such as glass.
  • the molecules can be directly covalently attached to the intermediate material (e.g. the hydrogel) but the intermediate material can itself be non-covalently attached to the substrate or matrix (e.g. the glass substrate). Covalent attachment to a solid support is to be interpreted accordingly as encompassing this type of arrangement.
  • the present invention comprises novel systems and devices for sequencing nucleic acids.
  • references herein to a particular nucleic acid sequence may, depending on the context, also refer to nucleic acid molecules which comprise such nucleic acid sequence.
  • Sequencing of a target fragment means that a read of the chronological order of bases is established. The bases that are read do not need to be contiguous, although this is preferred, nor does every base on the entire fragment have to be sequenced during the sequencing.
  • Sequencing can be carried out using any suitable sequencing technique, wherein nucleotides or oligonucleotides are added successively to a free 3' hydroxyl group, resulting in synthesis of a polynucleotide chain in the 5' to 3' direction.
  • the nature of the nucleotide added is preferably determined after each nucleotide addition.
  • Sequencing techniques using sequencing by ligation, wherein not every contiguous base is sequenced, and techniques such as massively parallel signature sequencing (MPSS) where bases are removed from, rather than added to, the strands on the surface are also amenable to use with the systems and devices of the invention.
  • MPSS massively parallel signature sequencing
  • the current invention utilizes sequencing-by-synthesis (SBS).
  • SBS sequencing-by-synthesis
  • four fluorescently labeled modified nucleotides are used to sequence dense clusters of amplified DNA (possibly millions of clusters) present on the surface of a substrate (e.g., a flowcell).
  • a substrate e.g., a flowcell.
  • the flowcells containing the nucleic acid samples for sequencing are placed within the appropriate flowcell holder of the present invention (various embodiments of which are described herein).
  • the samples for sequencing can take the form of single molecules, amplified single molecules in the form of clusters, or beads comprising molecules of nucleic acid.
  • the nucleic acids are prepared such that they comprise an oligonucleotide primer adjacent to an unknown target sequence.
  • one or more differently labeled nucleotides, and DNA polymerase, etc. are flowed into/through the flowcell by the fluid flow subsystem (various embodiments of which are described herein).
  • Either a single nucleotide can be added at a time, or the nucleotides used in the sequencing procedure can be specially designed to possess a reversible termination property, thus allowing each cycle of the sequencing reaction to occur simultaneously in the presence of all four labeled nucleotides (A, C, T, G).
  • the polymerase is able to select the correct base to incorporate and each sequence is extended by a single base.
  • the natural competition between all four alternatives leads to higher accuracy than wherein only one nucleotide is present in the reaction mixture (where most of the sequences are therefore not exposed to the correct nucleotide).
  • Sequences where a particular base is repeated one after another e.g., homopolymers
  • the fluid flow subsystem also flows the appropriate reagents to remove the blocked 3' terminus (if appropriate) and the fluorophore from each incorporated base.
  • the substrate can be exposed either to a second round of the four blocked nucleotides, or optionally to a second round with a different individual nucleotide. Such cycles are then repeated and the sequence of each cluster is read over the multiple chemistry cycles.
  • the computer aspect of the current invention can optionally align the sequence data gathered from each single molecule, cluster or bead to determine the sequence of longer polymers, etc. Alternatively, the image processing and alignment can be performed on a separate computer.
  • the heating/cooling components of the system regulate the reaction conditions within the flowcell channels and reagent storage areas/containers (and optionally the camera, optics, and/or other components), while the fluid flow components allow the substrate surface to be exposed to suitable reagents for incorporation (e.g., the appropriate fluorescently labeled nucleotides to be incorporated) while unincorporated reagents are rinsed away.
  • suitable reagents for incorporation e.g., the appropriate fluorescently labeled nucleotides to be incorporated
  • An optional movable stage upon which the flowcell is placed allows the flowcell to be brought into proper orientation for laser (or other light) excitation of the substrate and optionally moved in relation to a lens objective to allow reading of different areas of the substrate.
  • other components of the system are also optionally movable/adjustable (e.g., the camera, the lens objective, the heater/cooler, etc.).
  • the image/location of emitted fluorescence from the nucleic acids on the substrate is captured by the camera component, thereby, recording the identity, in the computer component, of the first base for each single molecule, cluster or bead.
  • Figure 2 displays a photograph of an exemplary arrangement of a system of the invention.
  • the system can be divided into several basic groupings, e.g., area 200 comprising fluidics and reagent storage (including pumps and motors or the like for producing and regulating fluid flow, heaters/coolers for proper reagent temperatures, etc.), area 210 comprising flowcell and detection (including one or more cameras or similar devices, one or more lasers or other light sources, one or more appropriate optical filters and lenses, a temperature control actuator, e.g., with Peltier heating/cooling for control of the temperature conditions of the flowcell, a movable staging platform and motors controlling such to correctly position the various devices/components within the system), and area 220 comprising a computer module (including memory and a user interface such as a display panel and keyboard, etc.).
  • a computer module including memory and a user interface such as a display panel and keyboard, etc.
  • FIG. 3 shows a photograph of a flowcell (flowcell 300) placed within an exemplary system.
  • a laser coupled through optical fiber 320 is positioned to illuminate the flowcell (which contains the nucleic acid samples to be sequenced) while an objective lens component (component 310) captures and monitors the various fluorescent emissions once the fluorophores are illuminated by a laser or other light.
  • reagents are flowed through the flowcell through one or more tubes (tube 330) which connect to the appropriate reagent storage, etc.
  • the flowcell in Figure 3 is placed within flowcell holder 340 (which is, in turn, placed upon movable staging area 350).
  • the flowcell holder keeps the flowcell secure in the proper position in relation to the laser, the prism (which directs laser illumination onto the imaging surface), and the camera system, while the sequencing occurs.
  • Other flowcells and flowcell configurations are set forth below.
  • the systems herein can use two excitation lasers coupled through a fiberoptic device to ensure that they illuminate the same area (i.e. that the illuminated areas, or footprints, of the lasers overlap).
  • the current invention can contain a shaking, squeezed, or waveplate modulated fiber (mode scrambler) such that the optical intensity from a multimode beam is made uniform over the whole illumination footprint.
  • the shape of the fiber may be adjusted, for example to be square or rectangular, such that the shape of the illumination can be matched to the shape of the data collection device (e.g., a CCD with square pixels).
  • a single laser excites two fluorophores, one with a narrow emission filter near the wavelength, and one with a wider band emission filter at longer wavelength.
  • Such arrangement normalizes the relative intensities of the two dyes (with the same bandwidth filters, the dye further from the laser wavelength would be much weaker).
  • the embodiments herein also can comprise a moving stage such that the chemistry (which requires heating and cooling) can happen on the same instrument, but out of the optical train.
  • the systems herein also often contain an autofocus system to allow automated imaging of many tiles, and contain a fluidics system for performing online fluidic changes.
  • the individual components of the system/device can optionally each have its own power source or supply or can optionally all be powered via one source.
  • the components herein are often described in isolation or in relation to only one or two other components, that the various components in the embodiments are typically operably and/or functionally connected and work together in the systems/devices herein.
  • the systems herein comprise one or more substrates upon which the nucleic acids to be sequenced are bound, attached or associated. See, e.g., WO 9844151 or WO0246456 .
  • the substrate is within a channel or other area as part of a "flowcell.”
  • the flowcells used in the various embodiments of the invention can comprise millions of individual nucleic acid clusters, e.g., about 2-8 million clusters per channel. Each of such clusters can give read lengths of at least 25 bases for DNA sequencing and 20 bases for gene expression analysis.
  • the systems herein can generate a gigabase (one billion bases) of sequence per run (e.g., 5 million nucleic acid clusters per channel, 8 channels per flowcell, 25 bases per polynucleotide).
  • Figures 4A and 4B display one exemplary embodiment of a flowcell.
  • flowcell 400 comprises base layer 410 (e.g., of borosilicate glass 1000 ⁇ m in depth), channel layer 420 (e.g., of etched silicon 100 ⁇ m in depth) overlaid upon the base layer, and cover, or top, layer 430 (e.g., 300 ⁇ m in depth).
  • base layer 410 e.g., of borosilicate glass 1000 ⁇ m in depth
  • channel layer 420 e.g., of etched silicon 100 ⁇ m in depth
  • cover, or top, layer 430 e.g., 300 ⁇ m in depth.
  • some flowcells can comprise openings for the channels on the bottom of the flowcell.
  • the channeled layer can optionally be constructed using standard photolithographic methods, with which those of skill in the art will be familiar.
  • One such method which can be used in the current invention involves exposing a 100 ⁇ m layer of silicon and etching away the exposed channel using Deep Reactive Ion Etching or wet etching.
  • various flowcells herein can comprise different numbers of channels (e.g., 1 channel, 2 or more channels, 4 or more channels, or 6, 8, 10, 16 or more channels, etc.
  • various flowcells can comprise channels of different depths and/or widths (different both between channels in different flowcells and different between channels within the same flowcell).
  • the channels formed in the cell in Figure 4B are 100 ⁇ m deep, other embodiments can optionally comprise channels of greater depth (e.g., 500 ⁇ m) or lesser depth (e.g., 50 ⁇ m).
  • FIG. 4C and 4D Additional exemplary flowcell designs are shown in Figures 4C and 4D (e.g., a flowcell with "wide" channels, such as channels 440 in Figure 4C , having two channels with 8 inlet and outlet ports (ports 445 - 8 inlet and 8 outlet) to maintain flow uniformity and a center wall, such as wall 450, for added structural support; or a flowcell with offset channels, such as the 16 offset channels (channels 480), etc.).
  • the flowcells can be designed to maximize the collection of fluorescence from the illuminated surface and obtain diffraction limited imaging.
  • the light comes into the channel through 1000 ⁇ m thick bottom layer 460, which can be made of borosilicate glass, fused silica or other material as described herein, and the emitted light travels through 100 ⁇ m depth of aqueous solution within the channel and 300 ⁇ m depth of "top" layer material 470.
  • the thickness of the "top" layer may be less than 300 ⁇ m to prevent spherical aberrations and to image a diffraction limited spot.
  • the thickness of the top layer can be around 170 ⁇ m for use with a standard diffraction limited optical system.
  • the objective can optionally be custom designed, e.g., as described herein.
  • the flowcells can be created from/with a number of possible materials.
  • the flowcells can comprise photosensitive glass(es) such as Foturan ® (Mikroglas, Mainz, Germany) or Fotoform ® (Hoya, Tokyo, Japan) that can be formed and manipulated as necessary.
  • Other possible materials can include plastics such as cyclic olefin copolymers (e.g., Topas ® (Ticona, Florence, KY) or Zeonor ® (Zeon Chemicals, Louisville, KY)) which have excellent optical properties and can withstand elevated temperatures if need be (e.g., up to 100°C).
  • the flowcells can comprise a number of different materials within the same cell.
  • the base layer, the walls of the channels, and the top/cover layer can optionally be of different materials.
  • FIG. 4B shows a flowcell comprised of 3 layers
  • other embodiments can comprise 2 layers, e.g., a base layer having channels etched/ablated/formed within it and a top cover layer, etc.
  • other embodiments can comprise flowcells having only one layer which comprises the flow channel etched/ablated/otherwise formed within it.
  • the flowcells comprise Foturan ® .
  • Foturan is a photosensitive glass which can be structured for a variety of purposes. It combines various desired glass properties (e.g., transparency, hardness, chemical and thermal resistance, etc.) and the ability to achieve very fine structures with tight tolerances and high aspect ratios (hole depth/hole width). With Foturan ® the smallest structures possible are usually, e.g., 25 ⁇ m with a roughness of 1 ⁇ m.
  • FIG. 5A gives a schematic diagram of one possible way of patterning a flowcell (e.g., one comprising Foturan ® ).
  • a flowcell e.g., one comprising Foturan ®
  • First the desired pattern is masked out with masks 500, onto the surface of substrate 510 which is then exposed to UV light.
  • the glass is exposed to UV light at a wavelength between 290 and 330 nm. It can be possible to illuminate material thicknesses of up to 2 mm. An energy density of approximately 20 J/cm 2 is typically sufficient to structurize a 1 mm thick Foturan ® plate.
  • silver or other doped atoms are coalesced in the illuminated areas (areas 520).
  • FIG. 6 panels A through E show an exemplary etching process to construct a sample flowcell as used herein.
  • channels 600 (seen in an end view) and through-holes 605 (seen in an end view) are exposed/etched into layer 630.
  • Layer 630 is the "top" layer of a two layer flowcell as can be seen in Figure 6E (mated with bottom layer 620).
  • the through-holes (where reagents/fluids enter into the flowcell channels) and channels can be etched into layer 630 through a 3-D process such as those available from Invenios (Santa Barbara, CA).
  • Top layer 630 can comprise Foturan which, as described, can be UV etched.
  • FIG. 6B layer 630 has been masked and light exposed to produce darkened areas 610 within the layer (similar to the masking in Figure 5A , but without the further etching). Such optically opaque areas can be helpful in blocking misdirected light, light scatter, or other nondesirable reflections that could otherwise negatively affect the quality of sequence reading herein.
  • a thin (e.g., 100-500 nm) layer of metal such as chrome or nickel is optionally deposited between the layers of the flowcell (e.g., between the top and bottom layers in Figure 6E ) to help block unwanted light scattering.
  • Figures 6C and 6D display the mating of bottom layer 620 with channel layer 630 and Figure 6E shows a cut away view of the same.
  • the layers of the flowcells are attached to one another in any of a number of different ways.
  • the layers can be attached via adhesives, bonding (e.g., heat, chemical, etc.), and/or mechanical methods.
  • bonding e.g., heat, chemical, etc.
  • the reagents, buffers, etc. used in the sequencing of the nucleic acids are regulated and dispensed via a fluid flow subsystem or aspect.
  • Figures 7A-C present generalized diagrams of exemplary fluid flow arrangements of the invention, set up in one way push, eight way pull, and one way pull configurations respectively.
  • the fluid flow subsystem transports the appropriate reagents (e.g., enzymes, buffers, dyes, nucleotides, etc.) at the appropriate rate and optionally at the appropriate temperature, from reagent storage areas (e.g., bottles, or other storage containers) through the flowcell and optionally to a waste receiving area.
  • reagents e.g., enzymes, buffers, dyes, nucleotides, etc.
  • the fluid flow aspect is optionally computer controlled and can optionally control the temperature of the various reagent components.
  • certain components are optionally held at cooled temperatures such as 4°C +/- 1°C (e.g., for enzyme containing solutions), while other reagents are optionally held at elevated temperatures (e.g., buffers to be flowed through the flowcell when a particular enzymatic reaction is occurring at the elevated temperature).
  • various solutions are optionally mixed prior to flow through the flowcell (e.g., a concentrated buffer mixed with a diluent, appropriate nucleotides, etc.).
  • a concentrated buffer mixed with a diluent, appropriate nucleotides, etc. Such mixing and regulation is also optionally controlled by the fluid flow aspect of the invention. It is advantageous if the distance between the mixed fluids and the flowcell is minimized in many embodiments. Therefore the pump can be placed after the flowcell and used to pull the reagents into the flowcell ( Figure 7B and 7C ) as opposed to having the pump push the reagents into the flowcell (as in Figure 7A ). Such pull configurations mean that any materials trapped in dead volumes within the pump do not contaminate the flowcell.
  • the pump can be a syringe type pump, and can be configured to have one syringe per flow channel to ensure even flow through each channel of the flowcell.
  • the pump can be an 8 way pump, if it is desired to use an 8 way flowcell, such as for example a Kloehn 8 way syringe pump (Kloehn, Las Vegas, NV).
  • a fluidics diagram of an 8 way pull configuration is shown in figure 7B .
  • fluidic reagents are stored in reagent containers 700 (e.g., buffers at room temperature, 5X SSC buffer, enzymology buffer, water, cleavage buffer, etc.) and 710 (e.g., cooled containers for enzymes, enzyme mixes, water, scanning mix, etc.).
  • Pump 730 moves the fluids from the reagent containers through reagent valve 740, priming/waste valve 770 and into/through flowcell 760.
  • fluidic reagents are stored in reagent containers 702 (e.g., buffers at room temperature similar to those listed above) and 703 (e.g., cooled containers for enzymes, etc. similar to those listed above), linked through reagent valve 701.
  • reagent valve 705 e.g., buffers at room temperature similar to those listed above
  • 703 e.g., cooled containers for enzymes, etc. similar to those listed above
  • reagent valve 701 e.g., buffers at room temperature similar to those listed above
  • the reagent valve is linked into flowcell 705 via an optional priming valve (or waste valve) 704, connected to optional priming pump 706.
  • the priming pump can optionally draw reagents from the containers up through the tubing so that the reagents are "ready to go" into the flowcell.
  • the fluidic configurations can comprise "sipper" tubes or the like that extend into the various reagent containers in order to extract the reagents from the containers.
  • Figure 7C shows a single channel pump rather than an 8 channel pump.
  • Single channel pump 726 can also act as the optional priming pump, and thus optional priming pump or waste valve 723 can be connected directly to pump 726 through bypass 725.
  • the arrangement of components is similar in this embodiment as to that of Figure 7B . Thus it comprises reagent containers 721 and 722, multi-way selector valve 720, flowcell 724, etc.
  • the fluid flow itself is optionally driven by any of a number of pump types, (e.g., positive/negative displacement, vacuum, peristaltic, etc.) such as an Encynova ® 2-1 Pump (Encynova, Greeley, CO) or a Kloehn ® V3 Syringe Pump (Kloehn, Las Vegas, NV).
  • pump types e.g., positive/negative displacement, vacuum, peristaltic, etc.
  • Encynova ® 2-1 Pump Encynova, Greeley, CO
  • a Kloehn ® V3 Syringe Pump Keloehn, Las Vegas, NV.
  • the fluid delivery rate is from about 50 ⁇ L to about 500 ⁇ L/min (e.g., controlled +/- 2 ⁇ L) for the 8 channels.
  • the flow can be between 10-100 ⁇ l/min/channel, depending on the process.
  • the maximum volume of nucleotide reagents required for sequencing a polynucleotide of 25 bases is about 12 mL.
  • the reagents are optionally transported from their storage areas to the flowcell through tubing.
  • tubing such as PTFE
  • the diameter of the tubing can vary between embodiments (and/or optionally between different reagent storage areas), but can be chosen based on, e.g., the desire to decrease "dead volume" or the amount of fluid left in the lines.
  • the size of the tubing can optionally vary from one area of a flow path to another.
  • the tube size from a reagent storage area can be of a different diameter than the size of the tube from the pump to the flowcell, etc.
  • the fluid flow subsystem of the invention also can control the flow rate of the reagents involved.
  • the flow rate is optionally adjustable for each flow path (e.g., some flow paths can proceed at higher flow rates than others; flow rates can optionally be reversed; different channels can receive different reagent flows or different timings of reagent flows, etc.).
  • the flow rate can be set in conjunction with the tube diameter for each flow path in order to have the proper volume of reagent, etc in the flowcell at a given time.
  • the tubing through which the reagents flow is 0.3 mm ID, 0.5 mm, or 1.0 mm while the flow rate is 480 ⁇ L/min or 120 ⁇ L/min.
  • the speed of flow is optionally balanced to optimize the reactions of interest.
  • High flow can cause efficient clearing of the lines and minimize the time spent in changing the reagents in a given flowcell volume, but can also cause a higher level of shear flow at the substrate surface and can cause a greater problem with leaks or bubbles.
  • a typical flow rate for the introduction of reagents can be 15 ⁇ l/min/channel in some embodiments.
  • the system can be further equipped with pressure sensors that automatically detect and report features of the fluidic performance of the system, such as leaks, blockages and flow volumes. Such pressure or flow sensors can be useful in instrument maintenance and troubleshooting.
  • the fluidic system can be controlled by the one or more computer component, e.g., as described below. It will be appreciated that the fluid flow configurations in the various embodiments of the invention can vary, e.g., in terms of number of reagent containers, tubing length/diameter/composition, types of selector valves and pumps, etc.
  • the systems herein comprise a heating/cooling control component having heating/cooling capabilities, e.g., through Peltier devices, etc.
  • the various components herein e.g., the flowcell and its contents
  • Such heating/cooling component(s) can control the temperature of the flowcells (and the fluids within them) during the various reactions required in sequencing-by-synthesis.
  • An exemplary flowcell temperature control system is shown in Figure 8 (in isolation from the other components of the system).
  • Peltier fan 800 is shown in relationship to heat sink 810 and Peltier heater 820.
  • the flowcell heating/cooling component is optionally positionable and/or movable in relation to the other components of the system (e.g., the flowcell and flowcell holder, etc.).
  • the heating/cooling component can be moved into place when needed (e.g., to raise the temperature of the reagents in the flowcell to allow for enzyme activity, etc.) and moved away when not needed.
  • the flowcell and flowcell holder can optionally be moved in relation to the heating/cooling component. See Figure 10A and 10B below.
  • the temperature control elements control the flowcell temperature, e.g., from about 20°C to about 60°C or any other temperature/temperature ranges as required by the reactions to be done within the systems/devices.
  • the temperature of the heating element can be adjusted to control the temperature of the flowcell and the reagents therein. As the flowcell is exposed to a flow of cooled reagents, the temperature of the heating element may be higher than the temperature desired at the surface of the flowcell. For example the heating element may be set to 55 °C to obtain a flowcell temperature of 45 °C.
  • Peltier devices used for temperature control (which can optionally be used in the systems herein). Again, it will be appreciated that while certain heating/cooling devices are recited herein, such should not be construed as necessarily limiting. Thus, in certain embodiments heating/cooling devices other than Peltier devices are optionally comprised within the present invention. In typical embodiments, notwithstanding the type of device, the heating/cooling component is optionally controlled (e.g., in terms of temperature, time at particular temperatures, movement of the component, and/or movement of other devices such as the flowcell holder to the heating/cooling component) by the computer component (see below).
  • additional heating/cooling elements can optionally regulate the temperature of other components in addition to or alternate to the flowcell.
  • heating/cooling components can optionally regulate the temperature of the camera, the reagent reservoirs, which can be cooled, for example to 4°C to prolong the storage life of the reagents during long sequencing runs, the temperature of the atmosphere inside the instrument etc.
  • the systems/devices can comprise additional approaches to flowcell configuration, TIR illumination, heating/cooling configurations of the flowcell(s), and in how the flowcells are held/stabilized within the device. While such approaches can optionally be utilized together in certain embodiments, it will be appreciated that they each can be used in any combination, e.g., with each other, with any of the other approaches described herein, etc.
  • the flowcells herein can be "bottom flow” flowcells.
  • some flowcells can comprise configurations that allow fluid flow that enters from the bottom of the flowcell.
  • Such bottom flowcells can be similar in construction and composition as "top flow” flowcells.
  • bottom flow flowcells can comprise less fluidic dead volume (and use more of the whole channel length than top flow flowcells, e.g., since the ends of the flowcells are not covered by clamps/manifolds, etc.). See, e.g., Figure 44- 49 .
  • Bottom flow flowcells can optionally be held to the flowcell holder through vacuum chucking rather than clamps.
  • a vacuum can hold the flowcell into the correct position within the device so that proper illumination and imaging can take place.
  • some embodiments herein also comprise one or more vacuum creation device to create a vacuum (or partial vacuum, etc.) to hold the flowcell and/or prism to the flowcell holder, XY stage, etc.
  • FIG 46 Various examples of flowcell holder manifolds are shown in Figure 46 that can be used with bottom flow flowcells. As can be seen, the fluids flowed into/through/out of the flowcell are directed through various branching tubes within the manifolds to/ from specific channels within the flowcell. Again, such embodiments can optionally not obstruct any (or not substantially any) of the top surface of the flowcell which might interfere with illumination/imaging of the full length of the channels.
  • Figure 47 displays an exemplary fluidic valve. Such valve has no moving parts or vibrations and a low dead volume. In such arrangements, each reagent bottle/container can have an open/close valve. After drawing a fluid, air can be injected before closing the reservoir valve thereby forcing an air gap valve between reagents. Cooled reagents can be returned to their reservoirs and all reagents in case of a system shut down. Also, an air injection pump can be added to the push/pull pump (e.g., a kloeh
  • top down illumination can be useful when used in conjunction with vacuum chucking (and bottom temperature control below). It can optionally be problematic to illuminate from the bottom (e.g., as in Figure 1 , etc.) in configurations with vacuum chucking and bottom temperature control since such embodiments often utilize the space below the flowcell.
  • top down or side illumination comes from above into prism 4401 upon which flowcell 4402 rests (and is optionally held down by vacuum). Such arrangement can also help prevent bowing of the flowcell which presentation can aid in autofocusing and flat field imaging and can aid in configuration with multiple flowcells having simultaneous reading, etc.
  • Laser illumination 4400 is also shown entering into the prism in Figure 44 as is mirror 4405 and manifold/fluidic connector 4404.
  • Figure 45 shows another approach to thermodynamic control of a flowcell (and the reagents and reactions within it).
  • Figure 45 shows an exemplary embodiment of a bottom temperature controlled device.
  • the aspect can comprise a water cooled bench that can help assure dimensional stability during read cycles and controlled scan buffer temperature.
  • a thermal plate can extend past the prism and flowcell and under the manifolds to optionally help in uniform temperature control. Fluids can optionally be preheated when passing through the inlet manifold.
  • RTD temperature feedback can be imbedded in top of the prism to assure that the flowcell is at the desired set temperature and that thermal resistant effects of the prism are minimized.
  • FIG. 48 Configurations having multiple flowcells within a flowcell holder are shown in Figure 48 .
  • up to four flowcells can be loaded into the holder in Figure 48A (or two double wide flowcells, e.g., having 18-20 channels each).
  • Peltiers or other similar devices can be beneath the flowcells and can optionally be water cooled through the holder bench aspect (which can be kept at room temperature optionally).
  • Placement and movement of the flowcell is controlled and secured by, e.g., a movable stage upon which the flowcell and flowcell holder (or other substrate) are located.
  • a movable stage can optionally allow movement of the flowcell in relation to the laser illumination and lens objective to read the sequencing reactions within the channels.
  • the scanning stage or other components can be actively cooled during the scanning cycle to control the temperature of the substrate during the imaging cycles.
  • Figure 9 panels A through D, displays schematic diagrams of an exemplary flowcell holder of the current system.
  • Figure 9A shows flowcell holder 900 before a flowcell is placed upon it.
  • the holder comprises adjustable clamps 910 (optionally spring loaded) to securely fasten the flowcell to the holder and optionally one or more manifolds (e.g., optionally comprised within the clamps) to fluidically connect the flowcell channels to the rest of the fluidic system.
  • a manifold can individually connect each of the channels in parallel.
  • a manifold can connect the channels such that they are connected via a single inlet line that is split to flow in parallel to each channel, or can be configured as a "serpentine" configuration to make a single fluid flow.
  • Such a manifold can be configured to contain a single 1-8 split, or can comprise a binary splitter wherein each fluid channel is only split into 2, to obtain a split from 1-2-4-8, in order to give a more uniform flow along each of the 8 channels.
  • the "exit" manifold from the flowcell can comprise 8 individual ports, each connected to a barrel of an 8 way syringe pump, whilst the "inlet” manifold can contain a single entry tube to reduce the length of tubing needed to fill the flowcell.
  • the inlet manifold can contain a 1-8 splitter or a binary 1-2-4-8 splitter for partitioning the flow evenly down each of the 8 channels.
  • Figure 9B also shows the presence of adjustable prism 920 that optionally can be raised/lowered to come into contact with the underside of the flowcell.
  • the prism is used in conjunction with the lasers in the TIRF activity.
  • oil e.g., immersion oil such as that available from Cargille, catalog #19570 or the like
  • Figure 9C shows placement of flowcell 930 upon the holder and prism
  • Figure 9D shows the flowcell clamped to the flowcell holder with handle/clamp 940 being lowered to help secure the clamps and flowcell.
  • the flowcell and flowcell holder can be situated upon a movable stage or platform.
  • stage optionally is adjustable along, X, Y, and Z axes. This allows fine scale height and placement adjustment of the flowcell in relation to the lasers, camera, lens optics, etc, and allows the surface of the flowcell to be kept in focus relative to the imaging device.
  • the movable stage can optionally allow the flowcell to be moved back and forth between the heating/cooling component and the optic/laser components (i.e., to allow enzymatic reactions when heated and to quantify the outcome of such reactions with the camera/laser components).
  • Figure 10 shows photographs depicting movement of flowcell 1020 and flowcell holder 1010 between the heating/cooling element (left picture) and the camera/laser elements (right picture).
  • the x and y components can allow the flowcell to be moved laterally (e.g., by 10s of centimeters), whilst the height can be adjusted (e.g., by 10s of nanometers) vertically to allow focusing of the images.
  • the stage also can be simply an XY stage with no vertical setting, and the lens objective can be adjustable in the Z plane to ensure focus is maintained.
  • the heating/cooling elements are optionally movable as well, e.g., in order to come into closer proximity with the flowcell, etc.
  • Figure 10 left picture heating/cooling device raised
  • Figure 10 right picture heating/cooling device lowered onto flowcell.
  • FIG 10A shows a photograph of the instrument before and during the heating step.
  • Peltier device 1000 (comprised of fan 1001, heat sink 1002 and heater unit 1003) moves in the vertical direction to come into contact with the flowcell 1020 and flowcell holder 1010 mounted on XY stage 1050. Reagents are introduced into the flowcell via tube 1040. The flowcell can move to a position located under camera 1030 for imaging.
  • a schematic representation of the device in the imaging location is shown in figure 10B , where the Peltier device 1070 is in the raised position (with fan 1071, heatsink 1072, and heater 1073), flowcell 1085 and stage 1086 are sited next to the fiber optic mount 1090 and below lens objective 1080.
  • the fiber optic mount is connected to the Z stage 1075, which also controls the height of lens objective 1080.
  • the flowcell is clamped in place onto the flowcell holder by the manifold lever/handle 1095.
  • the various components herein e.g., the laser components, heating/cooling components, etc.
  • the particular configuration of such framework and/or housing can optionally vary in different embodiments based upon, e.g., the particular components, their size, etc.
  • the framework keeps the various components secure and in the proper location and orientation while also optionally aiding in the movement of the components when necessary.
  • the framework should be rigid enough to prevent vibrations within the instrument and the various components.
  • the mode scrambler can be motion damped and vibrationally isolated from the stage to prevent shaking of the flowcell during imaging.
  • Figure 11A shows a schematic displaying an exemplary framework holding the camera (1100), heating/cooling components 1110, ( cf., Figure 8 ) flowcell and flowcell holder, and movable stage 1120. Additional aspects of framework and mounting that aid in tying together the various components and aspects of the device/system include various alignment and mounting pins/locations can be seen in Figure 11B which shows the bearing slide for laser piece vertical adjustment 1165 and flowcell leveling adjustment component 1175. Other frameworks and housing, including external covers (skins) for the housing can be seen in Figure 12 along with computer monitor 1201.
  • the incorporation of specific nucleic acid bases with their accompanying specific fluorescences is tracked via laser excitation and camera observation.
  • the illumination is performed using Total Internal Reflection (TIR) comprising a laser component.
  • TIR Total Internal Reflection
  • TIRF laser Total Internal Reflection Fluorescence
  • TIRF laser system Total Internal Reflection Fluorescence
  • xenon arc lamps all of which are also included in the current description of TIRF, TIRF laser, TIRF laser system, etc. herein).
  • a "TIRF laser” is a laser used with a TIRF system
  • a “TIRF laser system” is a TIRF system using a laser, etc.
  • the TIRF systems herein should also be understood to include those TIRF systems/instruments comprising non-laser based excitation sources.
  • the camera component comprises a CCD camera.
  • the laser comprises dual individually modulated 50 mW to 500 mW solid state and/or semiconductor lasers coupled to a TIRF ⁇ prism, optionally with excitation wavelengths of 532 nm and 660 nm.
  • the coupling of the laser into the instrument can be via an optical fiber to help ensure that the footprints of the two lasers are focused on the same area of the substrate (i.e., overlap).
  • the area wherein the laser(s) or other excitation source(s) illuminate the sample is typically desired to be spatially flat and uniform.
  • the devices/systems herein take advantage of properties of multimode fibers that allow propagation of all optical modes through their cores with near equal amplitude to produce a flat or top-hat profile illumination footprint from the laser on the illuminated substrate surface (e.g., the surface of a flowcell), etc.
  • the finite number of modes present in such fibers can constructively and destructively interfere with each other and produce local minima and maxima in the intensity profile of the laser (or other light).
  • some embodiments herein produce a substantially uniform footprint by use of dynamic mode scrambling by constantly changing the index of refraction within the illumination beam, e.g., by modulating the beam with a waveplate, or by shaking, squeezing or compressing one or more areas of a fiber carrying the illumination beam.
  • some embodiments of the current invention produce a substantially uniform flat-top output (i.e., a substantially uniform illumination/excitation footprint from a laser or light source) by dynamically scrambling the modes in an illuminating beam, e.g., by squeezing/compressing a fiber carrying the beam in one or more area over its length.
  • Figures 33 and 34 summarize various embodiments of mode scrambling as described herein. See below.
  • the devices herein comprise component(s) to produce a "top-hat” illumination, e.g., a uniform or substantially uniform illumination over a particular illumination footprint, as seen in Figure 35 .
  • Such embodiments comprise one or more aspects that dynamically change the index of refraction within the medium transmitting the illumination (e.g., a fiber) at one or more nodes.
  • a fiber can be squeezed at various locations along its length to induce a continuously changing index of refraction.
  • Such squeezing of the fiber e.g., a Step Index Fiber, can be used to spatially/temporally scramble the modes in the fiber to cause sufficient overlap over a desired integration time of the output illumination.
  • the fiber can also be shaken, rotated, vibrated or physically deformed in other ways to change the optical path through the fiber.
  • the dynamic scrambling of the modes in the fibers allows achievement of spatially uniform illumination over a minimum user defined integration time. This thus prevents interference of propagating modes of monochromatic light in multimode fibers which would produce light and dark patterns in the resulting beam. It is optionally sufficient that these modes disappear over the minimum integration time.
  • the relative path lengths of these modes within the illumination beam are rapidly varied by introducing time variable curvature and index variations into the fiber, e.g., by mechanical means.
  • dynamic mode scrambling comprises one or more aspects/components used to dynamically change the index of refraction of an illumination beam in order to average out an end illumination footprint. While many existing refractive optical concepts require an input Gaussian beam and existing diffractive optical concepts are often wavelength dependent, the present embodiment does not require a Gaussian beam input and is wavelength independent.
  • the devices/systems herein desire a uniformly illuminated field for excitation/measurement of the sequencing reactions, etc.
  • the uneven light/dark patterns that result from interference of propagating modes of monochromatic light in a multimode fiber is typically undesirable.
  • Averaging of the light output over an illumination footprint (over a period of observation time such as the time captured by a camera during an imaging) to allow integration of the light means that the light/dark patterns "disappear" or are averaged out, and thus the excitation intensity seen by each fluorophore on the surface should be uniform.
  • Underlying dynamic mode scrambling is the constant varying of the index of refraction at a point or node of the light beam over time (e.g., by physically squeezing a fiber over time) which causes the light to be scrambled and take different paths and thus averages out the light output in the illumination footprint.
  • the position of interference minima and maxima changes as the index of refraction of the input beam is changed. If the index of refraction is changed at a frequency that is faster than the image acquisition time, then a spatially uniform image can be produced in the timescale of the observation.
  • mode scramble which most often refers to randomization of an input mode or modes relative to the output.
  • the desired function of the current embodiment is to temporally as well as spatially randomize modes, i.e., producing dynamic scrambling.
  • the dynamic mode scrambling of the current embodiment can also be used in conjunction with fibers comprising cores of particular shapes to achieve a beam shape with uniform illumination. For example, squeezing a fiber with a square core will result in a uniformly illuminated square beam.
  • the beam can be shaped along a particular axis to make a rectangle, or oval shape, which beam is imaged as square or circular when it hits upon the imaging surface. See Figures 17-18 .
  • rectangular beams can be generated from optical fibers, as shown in Figure 34 .
  • Figure 35 shows the optical output from a variety of different lasers, fibers, and mode scrambling aspects, etc. During device operation, the ends of the fibers were re-imaged onto a beam profiler.
  • Figure 35 shows the effect of dynamic modescrambling (i.e., by manipulation of the fibers at one or more nodes with, e.g., piezo-electric actuators) by comparing the images from different wavelength lasers (e.g., 532 nm and 550 nm) and laser times (solid state and diode) in conjunction with different beam shapers (two versions of rectangles and a circle) by showing the output when the dynamic modescrambling is "on” versus the light output when the modescrambling is "off' for each laser type, etc.
  • different wavelength lasers e.g., 532 nm and 550 nm
  • laser times solid state and diode
  • one embodiment of the device can therefore comprise a dynamic mode scrambler as opposed to static mode scrambler. It is the dynamic variation of index of refraction that causes the modes to overlap over the desired integration time.
  • the index of refraction is constantly changed at one or more location (node).
  • a fiber transmitting the illumination is constantly squeezed at a point with a changing degree of intensity (e.g., from no squeezing to maximum squeezing and back again).
  • the fiber can be temporarily deformed by such squeezing so that its shape changes from a circle to an ellipse to a circle, etc. which, in turn, keeps changing the index of refraction.
  • the mode scrambling stops.
  • Efficiency of averaging of the illumination output in a footprint depends on length of image capture, the degree of change in index of refraction, the type/strength of the light source, etc. Thus, it is a user controllable variable and should not necessarily be taken as limiting.
  • the user can optionally control the degree of scrambling to fine tune the averaging of light output in a footprint.
  • the time period over which light output averaging is measured is variable, e.g., it can be the period during which an image is captured of the area illuminated by the light output (e.g., tiles (specific image capture areas) upon the flowcells in certain sequencing embodiments herein).
  • the time period of scrambling efficiency is equivalent to or substantially equivalent to the expose period for each image captured by a camera (e.g., the CCD camera in particular sequencing embodiments herein).
  • exposure times can vary from embodiment to embodiment, e.g., from less than 1 millisecond to over 1 hour or more depending upon the particular requirements of the embodiment (e.g., at least 1, 5, 10, 25, 50, 100, 250, 500 or more microseconds; at least 1, 5, 10, 25, 50, 100, 250, 500 or more milliseconds; at least 1, 5, 10, 25, 50, 100, 250, 500 or more seconds, etc.).
  • the imaging time may be of the order of 50-500 milliseconds per exposure.
  • the current dynamic mode scrambler can, no matter the overall system with which it is used, be used with different light sources/types, different beam media, different ways of changing the index of refraction, different numbers of nodes where the index of refraction is changed, etc.
  • Dynamic mode scrambling is not limited by the particular light/illumination used.
  • lasers of particular wavelength e.g., 532 and/or 660 nm
  • other embodiments can use illumination of entirely different wavelength.
  • the lasers used with dynamic mode scrambling can be, e.g., visible light lasers, IR lasers, narrow alignment lasers, broad linewidth lasers, etc.
  • particular laser wavelengths are mentioned herein, such recitation should not necessarily be taken as limiting.
  • other parameters are optionally adjusted to achieve substantially uniform illumination. For example, the number of nodes where the index of refraction is changed and/or the rate of change of the index at such nodes is optionally different for different light sources to achieve the same degree of uniformity of the footprint.
  • dynamic mode scrambling is also optionally used with light transmitted through glass, plastic, non-fiber optic lines, air, vacuum, etc.
  • dynamic mode scrambling is not limited by the medium in which the light is transmitted.
  • differences in the transmission medium can optionally also match with a difference in other aspects of the mode scrambler needed to achieve substantially uniform output.
  • the index of refraction is optionally changed/varied by changes in temperature rather than any mechanical change in the transport medium.
  • the index of refraction can optionally be varied through a number of ways. For example, as mentioned above, when the light is not transmitted through a cable/fiber, but rather traverses air/vacuum, the index of refraction of the light beam can be varied by changes in temperature. Thus, one or more heaters/coolers can be used to vary the temperature of one or more node of the light beam to change the index of refraction. For beams that travel through a fiber/cable, the physical properties of the fiber can be changed in order to vary the index of refraction. For example, the fiber can be physically bent, shaken, twisted, squeezed, compressed, pulled, or heated/cooled at one or more nodes to change the index of refraction at those points.
  • the physical interaction with the fiber can be through actual mechanical manipulation (e.g., through rollers, pinchers, etc. and/or through piezo-electric actuators that squeeze the fiber (e.g., similar to those available from General Photonics (Chino, CA)), etc.).
  • any way of varying the index of refraction can be used.
  • dynamic mode scrambling can comprise one or more node (i.e., area where the index is varied) on an illumination beam, which node can be fixed/static or movable along the light beam. In a general, but not limiting sense, the greater the number of nodes, the more scrambling occurs. Similarly, for multiple nodes it is typically preferred that the changes in refraction not be synchronized with one another (i.e., it is preferred that the variation in index of refraction be random).
  • Figures 33-35 show examples of mode scrambling with various fiber shapes and various light sources. As can be seen from the images, substantially uniform "top hat” illumination is achieved when the dynamic mode scramble is performed using a vibrating or squeezed fiber. The figures also illustrate that images can be shaped through use of shaped-core fibers.
  • Figure 33 shows a nonscrambled beam output (A) compared with beam outputs wherein the fiber was shaken, e.g., through use of a MKIII MS from Point Source (Hamble, UK) (B), vibrated, e.g., with an MKIV MS from Point Source (C), or squeezed, e.g., through use of one or more piezo-electric squeezer/compressors (e.g., squeezed over 6 nodes at about 500-600 Htz per node) (D).
  • the results shown in Figure 33 were all performed with the same fiber and laser types (e.g., 15 micron step index fiber and a 532 nm solid state laser).
  • the panels correspond to: 660 um wavelength diode laser in a rectangular core fiber with no mode scrambling (A) and the same fiber with dynamic mode scrambling (B); a 532 um wavelength solid state laser with no mode scrambling (C) and the same fiber with dynamic mode scrambling (D); a 660 um wavelength diode laser (a second rectangular) with no mode scrambling (E) and the same fiber with dynamic mode scrambling (F); a 532 solid state second rectangular fiber with no scrambling (G) and with dynamic mode scrambling (H); a 660 um diode laser (round) with no mode scrambling (I) and with dynamic mode scrambling (J); a 532 um solid state laser with no mode scrambling (K) and with dynamic mode scrambling (L).
  • specific beam shapes such as a square or rectangular laser beams are optionally used.
  • Such shaped illumination allows for efficient exposure and tiling over a surface, e.g., comprising a nucleic acid sample, which can result in higher throughput in various devices herein. This can be advantageous in cases where the imaging is performed using a CCD device with square pixels, as the illumination footprint and imaging area can be tiled to prevent illumination, and photobleaching of areas outside the image capture area.
  • the laser is coupled into a square or rectangular (or other shaped) core fiber.
  • a square or rectangular (or other shaped) core fiber the laser is coupled into a square or rectangular (or other shaped) core fiber.
  • all the available laser power is efficiently used for illumination.
  • Propagation down a sufficient length of such shaped fiber fills the core efficiently to produce the desired illumination shape.
  • the end of this fiber can then be re-imaged onto a sample, e.g., a flowcell substrate.
  • such re-imaging of the illumination from the fiber is typically desired to not substantially disturb the top-hat profile and/or beam shape achieved from scrambling and/or beam shaping (or even to distort the beam when it has not been beam shaped or scrambled).
  • re-imaging aspects e.g., lens(es), etc.
  • Re-imaging can also be chosen to be achromatic (i.e., to be able to function with any wavelength light).
  • re-imaging components can also be "pistoned" by slightly moving the reimaging components to have the illumination land properly on particular areas of the flowcell.
  • Illumination uniformity in such embodiments can optionally be controlled by the condition of the beam launched into the shaped fiber coupled with the length of the fiber. Illumination uniformity optionally can be enhanced by dynamically scrambling the modes within the shaped fiber. For example utilizing a device that continuously squeezes the shaped core fiber at various locations. See above.
  • the delivered beam dimensions at the sample surface optionally can be manipulated by imaging lenses.
  • Figures 34 and 35 show the results of use of a rectangular core optical fiber.
  • the end of the fiber was re-imaged onto a beam profiler.
  • the image from the beam profile illustrates the desired rectangular beam with uniform illumination in the vertical and horizontal dimensions.
  • the dynamic mode scrambling and/or beam shaping systems comprise components to generate and deliver a substantially uniform and wavelength-switchable evanescent beam to the lower surface of a flowcell channel (or other substrate) in an SBS reader instrument.
  • these components interface with several other modules/components in the overall SBS system (e.g., the various optics components described above, etc.), and can be controlled/directed through one or more computer component.
  • dynamic mode scrambling and beam shaping embodiments include, and are described throughout in terms of their interaction with, nucleic acid sequencing systems (e.g., various sequencing by synthesis configurations as described herein), it will be appreciated by those of skill in the art that such embodiments are also applicable to a wide range of other uses/systems.
  • dynamic mode scrambling can be included in myriad systems comprising one or more aspects to dynamically vary the index of refraction of an illumination beam to mix the optic modes of a multimode optical fiber in order to produce a substantially uniform image or output in a desired timeframe (e.g., such as during the image capture time for a camera or the like).
  • Dynamic mode scrambling can optionally be utilized with systems such as those tracking fluorescence on a plate or microarray or the like, i.e., uses that do not comprise tracking of sequencing reactions.
  • the invention comprises a system for mixing optic modes in a multimode optic fiber through use of waveplates.
  • waveplates comprise a light source (e.g., a laser) which sends light through a multimode optic fiber and also optionally through at least one waveplate and then optionally through a re-imaging lens(es), prism, and onto a substrate (flowcell).
  • the waveplates in such systems can comprise "rotating" waveplates. In some embodiments the waveplates actually physically rotate at various rpms, while in other embodiments, such as with liquid crystal waveplates, the plate "rotates” and alters the polarization of the light passing through it by varying voltage across the liquid crystal.
  • the waveplate comprises two or more sections of oriented retarders each of which rotates polarization in different directions.
  • the light output from the fiber comprises a substantially uniform light output on a surface over a defined time period.
  • the light output on the surfaces in various embodiments herein comprises reduced intensity minima and reduced intensity maxima in comparison to the output from a multimode optic fiber that does not comprise one or more rotating waveplates.
  • the invention comprises methods for equalizing light output from a multimode optic fiber over a surface in a defined time period by sending light from a light source (e.g., a laser) through a multimode optic fiber and through one or more rotating waveplates.
  • the output on the surface comprises reduced intensity minima and reduced intensity maxima as compared to the output from a multimode optic fiber that does not comprise one or more rotating waveplate.
  • the waveplates actually physically rotate at various rpms, while in other embodiments, such as with liquid crystal waveplates, the plate "rotates" and alters the polarization of the light passing through it by varying the voltage across the liquid crystal.
  • the waveplate comprises two or more sections of oriented retarders each of which rotates polarization in different directions.
  • a "waveplate” refers to an optical device that alters velocity of light rays as they pass through it, thus, creating a phase difference.
  • Waveplates are typically comprised of a birefringent crystal.
  • Some embodiments can comprise a liquid crystal waveplate.
  • the illumination of the sample (the area of which illumination is referred to as the "footprint") is spatially flat and uniform.
  • the optic instruments herein exploit the properties of multimode fibers that allow propagation of all optical modes through their core with near equal amplitude which produces a flat or top-hat profile of the footprint.
  • the finite number of modes present in such fibers can constructively and destructively interfere with each other, thus producing local minima and maxima in the intensity profile of the laser (or other light).
  • Some embodiments produce a uniform footprint by physically shaking the fiber at a timescale shorter than the exposure time of the camera capturing the images, which averages the intensity minima and maxima and produces a uniform flat top footprint.
  • This shaking can require an off balance DC motor that rotates and shakes the fiber, which in some instances can cause undesired noise and vibrations that need to be damped to avoid causing imaging problems.
  • the shaking can also adversely affect reliability since off balance DC motors have a shorter mean time between failure than balanced motors, and may increase physical wear on the fiber. Because of these factors, mode mixing in a multimode optical fiber without mechanical vibrations and, in some instances without moving parts, by using waveplates can be advantageous in some instances.
  • One embodiment of the current invention produces a substantially uniform flat-top beam (i.e., illumination/excitation area or footprint) by mixing the modes of the multimode optical fiber using a rotating ⁇ /2 waveplate (retarding plate).
  • the spatial content of the modes depends on the state of polarization of the input light. As polarization is changed, the spatial content is changed. Thus, the position of interference minima and maxima changes as the polarization of the input beam is changed.
  • the waveplate is rotated at an angular frequency that is faster than image acquisition time, then a spatially uniform image can be produced in the timescale of the observation.
  • the waveplate completes one or more rotation during a certain time period.
  • the time period is, e.g., one during which an image is captured of the area illuminated by the light output (e.g., substrate areas of the flowcells in certain sequencing embodiments herein).
  • the time period is equivalent to or substantially equivalent to the expose period for each image captured by a camera (e.g., a CCD camera in particular sequencing embodiments herein).
  • exposure times can vary from embodiment to embodiment, e.g., from less than 1 msec to over 1 hour or more depending upon the particular requirements of the embodiment (e.g., at least 1, 5, 10, 25, 50, 100, 250, 500 or more ⁇ sec; at least 1, 5, 10, 25, 50, 100, 250, 500 or more msec; at least 1, 5, 10, 25, 50, 100, 250, 500 or more seconds, etc.).
  • the exposure time may be 50-500 milliseconds.
  • the waveplates can rotate less than or more than a full rotation during the time period, thus, in some embodiments, aliasing can also be included.
  • a ⁇ /2 waveplate (see waveplate 3800 in Figure 38 ) in a suitable housing is rotated by a suitable DC motor or the like, operating at a speed fast enough so that a spatially substantially uniform image is produced during the appropriate image capture time.
  • Other embodiments comprise modified waveplate(s) which consist of several sections of oriented waveplates or smaller pieces, with the fast axis oriented in different directions (see waveplate 3900 in Figure 39 ). Since sections rotate the polarization in different ways/amounts, a much faster mixing of the modes can occur and the DC motor optionally does not rotate as fast as in the embodiments with several sections.
  • liquid crystals such as, but not limited to, those manufactured by Meadowlark Optics (Frederick, CO)
  • the polarization can be rotated by varying the voltage across the device.
  • Figure 40 shows a schematic diagram representing an exemplary arrangement of an embodiment of the invention.
  • linearly polarized light 4100 (200mW, 532nm) from diode pumped solid state laser (4200) is attenuated by use of several OD filters.
  • the intensity of the beam is further controlled by ⁇ /2 waveplate 4900 (e.g., Casix, Fuzhou, Fujian, China) and polarizing beamsplitter cube 4300 (e.g., Thorlabs, Newton, NJ).
  • ⁇ /2 waveplate 4900 e.g., Casix, Fuzhou, Fujian, China
  • polarizing beamsplitter cube 4300 e.g., Thorlabs, Newton, NJ.
  • the entire laser intensity is not needed, thus, in the example described only about 0.1 ⁇ W is used.
  • Rotation of the waveplate 4900 allows a precise control of the input laser power while keeping the polarization fixed.
  • the beam is then passed through second ⁇ /2 retarding waveplate 4400 and steered by two mirrors 4500 and 4600 into microscope objective 4700 (e.g., Nikon, 20x NA 0.3).
  • the microscope objective reduces the beam to the required size to be accepted by multimode optical fiber, 4800 200 ⁇ m core, 0.22NA (e.g., OZ optics, Ottawa, Canada).
  • the output end of the fiber in the embodiment shown is placed directly on the chip of CCD camera 4905 (e.g., Cascade 512, Photometrics, Arlington, AZ).
  • the camera was operated in frame transfer mode and exposures of 100 ms were adequate to capture the beam profile as explained herein.
  • the current invention can comprise different waveplates (e.g., different in terms of type, placement, arrangement, construction, etc.), different mirrors and beam splitters (e.g., different in terms of type, location, angle, etc.).
  • different embodiments can comprise, e.g., ⁇ /2 waveplates, ⁇ /4 waveplates (e.g., when the input polarization is circular), ⁇ /n waveplates of other specific retardation, etc., and can comprise at least 1 waveplate, at least 2 waveplates, at least 3 waveplates, or at least 5 or more waveplates in various arrangements.
  • the waveplates of the invention are not necessarily limited by their construction.
  • solid crystal e.g., crystal quartz, or any other appropriate substance
  • liquid crystal waveplates are included herein.
  • the embodiments can include systems comprising one or more waveplate (typically rotating) that mixes the optic modes of a multimode optical fiber in order to produce a spatially substantially uniform image or output in a desired timeframe (e.g., such as during the image capture time for a camera or the like).
  • the current waveplate aspects can optionally be utilized with systems, such as those tracking fluorescence on a plate or microarray or the like, that is not a sequencing reaction.
  • the waveplate aspects can also include methods to create a substantially uniform image or output from a multimode optic fiber in a desired timeframe by passing the optic modes of the fiber through one or more waveplate (typically rotating and typically rotating at a speed faster than the image capture time or desired timeframe).
  • Figure 41 Various images obtained from exposure of a camera from such exemplary embodiments are shown in Figure 41 . From a single exposure, the prominent regions of bright and dark pixels are evident in Figure 41A . The bright/dark images result from constructive and destructive interference of various modes that are present in the multimode optical fiber. Rotation of the waveplates results in spatial redistribution of the dark and bright regions as shown in the series of images in Figure 41B . In such Figures, each image was taken at a different waveplate setting. As mentioned previously, if the waveplate is rotated faster than the image acquisition time, then the spatial profile is averaged and uniform smoothing of the image results. Such uniform smoothing is comparable to obtaining a large number of images and averaging them.
  • Figures 41C and 41D show a single image with its line profile (41C) and an average of 54 images with associated line profile (41D).
  • Figure 42 shows the substantial uniformity of the footprint produced by use of the waveplate(s).
  • the diffuser can be a holographic diffuser that would superimpose light waves originating at the end of the fiber (if fiber coupled) or at the laser (if no fiber were present) in such a way that the waves superimpose and produce the required beam shape.
  • the various mode scrambling aspects herein can optionally be controlled/manipulated through the one or more computer component and are typically coordinated/synched with the light illumination and light detection components (also typically by the computer aspects herein).
  • the detector component can comprise a 1 mega pixel CCD-based optical imaging system such as a 1024 x 1024 back thinned CCD camera with 8 ⁇ m pixels, which at 40x magnification can optionally image an area of 0.33 x 0.33 mm per tile using a laser spot size of 0.5 x 0.5 mm (e.g., a square spot, or a circle of 0.5 mm diameter, or an elliptical spot, etc.).
  • the cameras can optionally have more or less than 1 million pixels, for example a 4 mega pixel camera can be used.
  • the readout rate of the camera should be as fast as possible, for example the transfer rate can be 10 MHz or higher, for example 20 or 30 MHz. More pixels generally mean that a larger area of surface, and therefore more sequencing reactions, can be imaged simultaneously for a single exposure. This has the advantage of requiring fewer stage moves and filter wheel changes, and helps to speed up imaging.
  • the CCD camera/TIRF lasers herein are capable of collecting about 6400 images to interrogate 1600 tiles (since images are optionally done in 4 different colors with optionally different filters in place) per cycle.
  • certain images optionally can contain between about 5,000 to 50,000 randomly spaced unique nucleic acid clusters (i.e., images upon the flowcell surface).
  • the theoretical density of resolvable clusters per unit area (or image) is dependant of the size of the clusters, as shown in Figure 29 which shows a IMpix image of the number of detected clusters as a function of total cluster number and minimum cluster area.
  • Figure 29 shows a IMpix image of the number of detected clusters as a function of total cluster number and minimum cluster area.
  • the systems herein can optionally quantify about 45 million features per hour. At a faster imaging rate, and higher cluster density, the imaging rate can be significantly improved.
  • the readout can be 1 million clusters per second.
  • the instrument can be configured to have more than a single camera.
  • the light can be split to simultaneously image two colors onto two cameras, or even four colors onto four cameras. If four cameras are used in parallel, it is thus possible to sequence 1 million bases per second, or 86.4 billion bases per day.
  • the excitation blocker e.g., as shown in Figure 36 can comprise a dual notch filter (e.g., 532 and 660 nm).
  • a picture of an instrument with two detection cameras 3700 and two fluidics systems 3701 (and two flowcells 3702) is shown in Figure 37 .
  • a "tile” herein is functionally equivalent to the image size mapped onto the substrate surface.
  • Tiles can be, e.g., 0.33 mm 2 , 0.5 mm 2 , 1 mm 2 , 2 mm 2 etc, although the size of the tile will depend to a large extent on the number and size of pixels on the camera and the desired level of magnification. Also, it will be appreciated that the tile does not have to equal the same size or shape as the illumination footprint from the laser (or other light source), although this can be advantageous if the minimization of photobleaching is desired.
  • the camera/laser systems collect fluorescence from 4 different fluorescent dyes (i.e., one for each nucleotide base type added to the flowcell).
  • SBS sequencing can be found in applicants' co-pending applications, for example WO04018497 , WO04018493 and US7057026 (nucleotides), WO05024010 and WO06120433 (polymerases), WO05065814 (surface attachment techniques), and WO 9844151 , WO06064199 and WO07010251 (cluster preparation and sequencing).
  • Figures 1 and 13-16 show various possible configurations of the cameras and lasers of the present invention, including a backlight design, a TIRF Imaging configuration, a laser focusing configuration, a white-light viewing configuration, and an alternative laser focusing design.
  • the white light excitation source is optional, and can be used as well as, or instead of, the excitation lasers.
  • Figure 1 shows the backlight design system whilst recording an image in the TIRF imaging configuration.
  • the configuration in Figure 1 for the TIRF imaging is optionally a configuration of the backlight design setup shown in Figure 13 .
  • one of the two lasers (in laser assembly 160) is used to illuminate the sample (in flowcell 110), and a single one of the four emission filters (in filter switching assembly 145) is selected to record a single emission wavelength and to cut out any stray laser light.
  • both focus laser (150) and optional white light lamp (165) do not illuminate the sample as they are either blocked with a shutter or switched off.
  • Laser illumination 101 and illumination from the flowcell up through the lens objective and camera 102 are also shown.
  • Figure 13 shows all the components of the system in the backlight design but without the specific TIRF imaging configuration. Cf. Figures 1 and 13 .
  • Figure 13 shows: fluid delivery module 1300, flowcell 1310, waste valve 1320, temperature actuator 1330, heating/cooling component (e.g., Peltier) 1335, camera (e.g., CCD camera) 1340, lens objective 1342, filter switching assembly 1345, focusing laser assembly 1350, excitation lasers assembly 1360, low watt lamp 1365, precision XY stage 1370, focus (z-axis) device 1375, mirror 1380, "reverse" dichroic 1385, and laser fiber optic 1390.
  • heating/cooling component e.g., Peltier
  • camera e.g., CCD camera
  • Figure 14 shows a similar system as that in Figure 1 , but in the laser focusing configuration where the excitation lasers (in laser assembly 1460) and optional white light 1465 are switched off.
  • Focusing laser 1450 is on and shines into the system, hits beam splitter 1485 (e.g., a pick-off mirror 1% beam splitter) which direct a faint beam 1402 down the objective to hit a small spot on the sample (in flowcell 1410).
  • the scattered light from the sample returns up objective (1442) through an empty slot in filter wheel switching assembly 1445 and is imaged by CCD camera 1440.
  • the position of the spot on the camera is used to ensure the sample is at the right distance from the objective, and therefore the image will be in focus.
  • Figure 15 shows the optional white light viewing configuration, where focus laser 1550 and illumination lasers 1560 are off.
  • the white light from low watt lamp 1565 goes into the system as beam 1503 and is imaged directly on the camera.
  • the numbering of elements, except for beam 1503, etc. follows that of Figures 13 and 14 .
  • Figure 16 shows an alternative focus configuration where the system contains second focusing camera 1641, which can be a quadrant detector, PSD, or similar detector to measure the location of the scattered beam reflected from the surface. This configuration allows for focus control concurrent with data collection.
  • the focus laser wavelength is optionally longer than the reddest dye emission filter.
  • Figures 17-19 show various schematics for beam shape and dimensions for TIRF assays carried out with use of the current systems herein, while Figure 20 displays an optional embodiment of a TIRF prism for use with the systems herein.
  • shape e.g., round, square, etc.
  • Figure 17 shows the dimensions and geometries of the beam as it emerges from the fiber. In order to illuminate a circle on the substrate, the beam must be projected from the fiber as an ellipse since the beam hits the substrate surface at an angle to the normal.
  • Edge view 1700 of circle projected by ellipse 1730 (e.g., an elliptical beam shape required at fiber exit (looking down fiber centerline at 22°).
  • the prism face partial outline 1710 is not to scale and the edge view 1720 of ellipse 1730 is shown on the minor axis.
  • the beam must be projected onto the surface as a rectangle, as shown in Figure 18 .
  • rectangle 1830 is shown.
  • a rec-elliptical beam shape is required at fiber exit (looking down fiber centerline at 22°).
  • Edge view 1800 of the square projected by rectangle 1830 is also indicated as is prism face partial outline 1830 (not to scale) and edge view 1820 of rec-ellipse 1830 (minor axis).
  • the prism is designed to allow the imaging beam to hit the substrate surface at approximately 68° (relative to the normal) to achieve a total internal reflection and generate an evanescent beam that excites the fluorophores on the surface.
  • the prism may have a geometry where the angle of the prism to the surface is also 68°, thereby ensuring that the light always hits the prism at 90°.
  • the desired geometry of the prism is more fully described in application WO03062897 , and the exemplary size and geometry is shown in Figure 20 , etc.
  • Beam shape of the lasers herein is optionally controlled by polishing the multimode fiber output end in order to create, e.g., a square beam. See, e.g., Figures 21.
  • Figure 21 shows imaged beam results from such polishing.
  • the beam is optionally round.
  • the beam properties may be a Gaussian profile with the following properties: a nominal image size of radius 0.17 mm, a maximal spot size of 0.25 mm radius, and 0.32 mm as the point after which there is effectively no laser intensity.
  • the beam intensity is greater than 90% maximum intensity at all positions within the nominal image size; 80% maximum intensity at all positions within the maximal spot size, and no greater than 1% of maximal intensity outside of 0.32 radius.
  • the intensity at any point does not vary by more than 5% RMS within the timescale of 1s-1h and the variation in the total (integrated) laser power is not more than 3% RMS measured over 24 hours.
  • the illumination systems can comprise lamps and/or lasers.
  • the systems can contain one or more illumination lasers of different wavelengths.
  • the systems herein may contain two lasers of 532 nm and 660 nm, although lasers with other wavelengths may also be used.
  • the lasers in the systems herein are actively temperature controlled to 0.1C, have TTL modulation for the 660 nm laser diode with rise time less than 100 ms; have integrated manual shutters for fast modulation of the 532 nm laser, have integrated beam shaping optics to ensure the optimum beam aspect ratio is maintained at the instrument interface to maximize signal to noise ratio, have integrated mode scrambler to reduce ripple on the output of the multi-mode fiber, and have minimal heat generation.
  • the shutters and TTL modulation are used to ensure that the illumination is only on the sample surface whilst the camera is recording images. Illumination of fluorophores can cause photobleaching, and therefore exposure of substrates to the laser when not needed is generally minimized, especially before the images are recorded.
  • Figures 22A and B give various filter wheel arrangements of certain embodiments for use with various optic configurations.
  • the use of a two laser excitation system to detect four fluorophores means that two of the fluorophores are excited away from their maximum absorbtion wavelength, as shown in figure 22B . If the emission filters used in all four channels were the same band width, then the two fluorophores nearest the 532 and 660 nm lasers would be significantly brighter than the two fluorophores excited further from the lasers. However, this factor can be negated by changing the bandwidth of the filters. For example, as shown in figure 22B , in the case of the 532 nm laser, dyes that absorb at for example 530 and 560 nm can both be excited by the 532 laser.
  • the use of a narrow filter close to the laser for example a 560/20 that lets light through from 550-570 nm only allows the light from the 532 nm dye through.
  • the use of a wider bandpass filter further away from the laser for example a 610/75 that allows light through from 572 nm to 647 nm lets through the light from both fluorophores.
  • the intensity of the 532 fluorophore through the 560/20 filter is similar to the intensity of the 560 fluorophore through the 610/75 filter.
  • the two fluorophores can be clearly distinguished using a single laser and two emission filters.
  • the effect is not wavelength specific, and can be performed using any excitation wavelength. The same effect can therefore be achieved using the red laser.
  • Two fluorophores that absorb at 650 nm and 680 nm can be distinguished using a narrow filter close to the laser (for example a 682/22), and a broader filter further away, for example a 700 long pass. Again the intensities of the two dyes through their respective filters is similar, whilst the signal from the 680 dye in the 682/22 filter is much reduced. Both dyes emit into the 700 long pass channel, but the signals can clearly be determined due to the different level of emission in the narrow filter.
  • the adaptation of laser wavelengths, fluorophore selections and filter bandwidths can be used to obtain a set of four fluorophores using any number of wavelengths, and the intensities of the emission through each channel can be normalized using the bandwidth of the filters to control how much light is transmitted.
  • Figure 23 shows a nominal design for an embodiment of the 30x system ray trace
  • Figure 24 shows the 30x imaging performance.
  • the imaging performance of the system is dependent on the magnification of the objective lens, and the other lenses in the system.
  • a smaller magnification will allow a larger area of the substrate to be imaged, but at a cost of resolution of closely packed clusters and the brightness of each cluster.
  • a preferred magnification is optionally between 10X-40X, for example 20X or 30X.
  • the objective can be custom designed to allow diffraction limited imaging to be retained when viewing fluorescence objects through a non-standard geometry (for example thicker glass substrates) and hence removing the otherwise present spherical aberration.
  • the objective lens may be connected to the detector via a further tube lens.
  • the systems herein can comprise components to aid in proper focusing of imaging clusters.
  • an autofocus laser beam shines down to a sample through an objective lens, reflects from the flowcell surface, goes back to the lens and then to the camera, thus creating a spot on the image.
  • the spot centroids align around a straight line on the image (calibration curve). Displacement "dr" along this calibration line is proportional to the change "d(z-zf)" in the distance between the objective and the focal plane.
  • the software establishes the orientation of the calibration line (its slope) and the "sensitivity": dz/dr (nm/pixel). This is accomplished by taking 21 images with the step of 1000 nm in z-direction around focus position which is established visually.
  • the software also can require the x, y pixel coordinates of the spot when the sample is in focus: x f , y f . this is determined from the first (central) focus image from the set of the 21 calibration images.
  • the devices herein optionally comprise an auto focus function objective achieving 100 nm resolution mounted with up to 50 mm Z axis motion.
  • the objective lens can optionally move vertically in relation to the substrate, and the illumination laser can be coupled to the Z axis motion such that the illumination inputs also move in relation to the substrate.
  • an autofocus beam is optionally sent along the edge of the microscope objective lens (optionally as far off-axis as possible in order to correspond to maximum sensitivity).
  • the autofocus beam can come from the illumination lasers, or from a separate source that is optionally a different wavelength than the illumination laser, for example 488 nm, 630 nm or an infra-red laser of 700 nm or redder.
  • the reflected beam is then optionally monitored by either a quad cell or by leakage through a dichroic beam splitter onto the fluorescence imaging camera.
  • the lens and camera are optionally the same as that used in the instrument (e.g., 20X lens). Similar autofocus systems which are optionally included within the current systems and devices have been previously described, for example in WO03060589 .
  • the reflected monitoring beam also optionally moves laterally (i.e. dotted line is the in focus plane while the solid line represents an out of focus plane which gives rise to a lateral shift in the detected beam in Figure 25 ).
  • the dichroic mirror chosen in such embodiments is usually one that reflects the autofocus beam.
  • the small leakage that is actually transmitted (c.a. ⁇ 5%) is more than adequate to observe on a CCD camera with no emission filter in the emission path.
  • Figure 26 shows sample photographs of both out of focus and in focus images where the spot is seen on the imaging camera. The lower images show the detected autofocus spot on the imaging camera. The spot can also be seen on a separate detector, as shown in Figure 27 .
  • the computer component optionally comprises an autofocus algorithm.
  • Such algorithms optionally aid in the determination of the correct focus (e.g., by monitoring the above measurements and adjusting accordingly).
  • the autofocus spot can be made to move in a 1D manner e.g. in just the y-direction rather than x & y, thus simplifying the procedure.
  • the focus position of the objective lens is assumed to move in the z-direction.
  • the first step in some embodiments of the autofocus analysis is a "Setup Response function" wherein positions of the autofocus spot (y 1 , y 2 ....y n ) are measured on the imaging camera for several positions of the objective lens (z 1 ,z 2 ...z n ). Typically 5 positions are adequate. Shown in Figure 27 is an analysis with just 3 positions. The movement of the reflected spot is shown as imaged on a fluorescence camera in the lower panels. For each Z plane there is an associated y-position of the reflected spot (centroid) on the camera.
  • the next step in such embodiments of the autofocus analysis comprises "Calculate newC (for out of focus position)" wherein for each position c is constant, i.e. doesn't change for an out of focus or in focus position. However, it does change for different positions.
  • Another aspect in auto focus components of the invention comprises laser pointing stability requirements.
  • the pixel size is roughly 0.3 ⁇ m.
  • the focal length of that lens is 10 mm.
  • the error angle that corresponds to 1 pixel is approximately 30 ⁇ rad.
  • Some embodiments of the system have their auto focus set for a sensitivity of about 4 pixel shift of the auto focus laser spot per micron of z motion.
  • the first step in some embodiments of the focus tracking procedure is to obtain the image of the autofocus laser spot on an imaging device, which may be the imaging camera. Data from this primary spot is extracted in two passes-a first coarse pass that determines the approximate position and size of the spot, followed by a second fine pass that determines the spot boundaries correctly before determining the COL (Center of Light) and other spot features.
  • the first pass analysis can be performed in 5 steps: (1) the 16-bit image is converted to an 8-bit image, with maximum of the image set to 255, minimum of image set to 0, and all other grayscale values linearly in between; (2)
  • the Picture Quality of the image is computed. Picture quality is defined as the average of the normalized autocorrelation of the image with itself with shifts of unit pixel to the left and unit pixel down.
  • this image is thresholded at 128. Anything above this value will be regarded as foreground, while anything below this level will be seen as background.
  • region-grow to find all 8-connected foreground components; (4) Of all these candidate foreground components, the component with the highest average brightness is chosen as "the" component specifying the position and approximate size of the primary spot; and (5) The bounding box of this component is computed.
  • the second (fine) pass analysis is performed in three steps: (1) The subimage corresponding to twice the area of the bounding box is cut out from the 8-bit grayscale image. This makes the population of foreground and background pixels approximately equal, thereby making it easier for standard image histogram based thresholding techniques to work reliably; (2) The histogram of the subimage is computed and the "best" grayscale threshold that separates foreground from background is determined. The threshold used is called “Otsu's Threshold” (see IEEE Trans. Systems, Man, and Cybernetics, vol. 9, pp. 62-66, 1979 , or Computer and Robot Vision, volume 1. Addison-Wesley, 1992 .); and (3) The image is thresholded at the Otsu threshold and the 8-connected foreground component is determined. This is the primary spot blob on which every subsequent feature extraction is carried out.
  • An additional pass can be carried out to extract the position of the secondary spot.
  • Four steps can be done to carry out such additional pass: (1) The 8-bit image (from the First Pass) is thresholded at a low threshold of 16; (2) It should be noted that at this lower threshold, the number of pixels (area) of the primary spot component increases. This area of the primary spot is recorded and is used to determine how tight or diffuse it is; (3) The component (of sufficient size) closest in distance to the primary spot component is identified as the secondary spot; (4) The geometric centroid of the secondary spot is recorded.
  • the list of features calculated for the primary spot blob includes Area which is a measure of how diffuse (non-tight) the primary blob is. This is set to the area (count in pixels) of the primary blob at the low threshold divided by its area at the Otsu threshold.
  • Other features calculated include Volume (the average brightness, above threshold ⁇ Area of the primary blob); Average Brightness, which is the sum of the gray values of the pixels in the blob divided by its area; and Maximum Brightness: Maximum gray value.
  • the extracted data can then be used to calibrate the Z focus, and thereby determine how much to move the objective in order for the image to be in focus.
  • the overview of the calibration procedure is as follows: (1) Calibration for the Z focus is done (with user help) at the beginning of every run; (2) At the beginning of calibration the user makes sure that the image is in focus, i.e. at the focal plane. He/she thus sets the Z focus point z F ; (3) This embodiment of autofocus relies on user input and the coordinates of the autofocus laser spot on an image; (4) As z is changed during the Calibration process, the spot moves in linear proportion to the change of z along a line.
  • the calibration algorithmic procedure begins with a sequence of Center of Lights ( x , y ) extracted from the sequence of autofocus spot images acquired as z is changed. Ideally these points when graphed should all fall perfectly on a straight line, shown below.
  • Input A sequence of Center of Lights ( x, y ) extracted from the sequence of autofocus spot images acquired as z is changed.
  • Output The PCA Regression Coefficients, i.e. transformation to the (R, Q) coordinate space. Description: Perform Principal Component Analysis and save the coefficients. Also, given the centroid position of the secondary spot, determine whether it is to the left or the right of the primary spot along the principal axis.
  • Input The r coordinates obtained from the PCA Regression, the corresponding z values, and the Z focus point z F .
  • Output The Linear Regression Coefficients relating ( z - z F ) to r . Description : Perform Linear Regression Analysis and save the coefficients.
  • An outlier detection scheme is used to warn the presence of a bubble or to flag a filter wheel problem.
  • Input The q coordinates obtained from the PCA Regression, along with the spot features for every spot in the calibration sequence are used to train a classifier to detect outlier spots.
  • Output Internal settings of the Outlier Detector. Description: For every feature ⁇ , the mean ⁇ ⁇ and standard deviation ⁇ ⁇ is calculated from the spots used during calibration. The general idea is that a spot would be declared an outlier spot if the feature ⁇ is outside the bounds of ⁇ ⁇ ⁇ 3 ⁇ ⁇ . However in the current implementation only the Volume and Area features are used in this way-in fact, only the upper bounds are currently used for these two features. Special bounds are set to override these values for both the picture quality and the q residue feature. For the picture quality, a lower bound is used. For the residue, an upper bound is used.
  • a run starts from an image of the autofocus laser spot and uses the coefficients of the transformations learned during the calibration process to make the best estimate for the z displacement required to move to focus.
  • Input An image of the autofocus laser spot.
  • Output ( z - z F ) to move to focus. Also provides recommendation of whether or not to move based upon outlier detection. Description : Derives best estimate of ( z - z F ) using: 1. The spot extraction algorithm. , 2. The PCA based XY Regression coefficients. 3. The Linear RZ Regression coefficients.
  • the outlier detection scheme allows a move only in the case of a large q residual. In case of low picture quality, high volume, or high area, it recommends non-movement.
  • the various components of the present system are coupled to an appropriately programmed processor or computer that functions to instruct the operation of these instruments in accordance with preprogrammed or user input instructions, receive data and information from these instruments, and interpret, manipulate and report this information to the user.
  • the computer is typically appropriately coupled to these instruments/components (e.g., including an analog to digital or digital to analog converter as needed).
  • the computer optionally includes appropriate software for receiving user instructions, either in the form of user input into set parameter fields, e.g., in a GUI, or in the form of preprogrammed instructions, e.g., preprogrammed for a variety of different specific operations (e.g., auto focusing, SBS sequencing, etc.).
  • the software then converts these instructions to appropriate language for instructing the correct operation to carry out the desired operation (e.g., of fluid direction and transport, autofocusing, etc.).
  • the computer is optionally used to direct a fluid flow component to control fluid flow, e.g., through a variety of tubing.
  • the fluid flow component optionally directs the movement of the appropriate buffers, nucleotides, enzymes, etc., into and through the flowcell.
  • the computer also optionally receives the data from the one or more sensors/detectors included within the system, and interprets the data, either provides it in a user understood format, or uses that data to initiate further controller instructions, in accordance with the programming, e.g., such as in monitoring and control of flow rates, temperatures, and the like.
  • the computer typically includes software for the monitoring and control of materials in the flowcells. Additionally the software is optionally used to control excitation of the fluorescent labels and monitoring of the resulting emissions.
  • the computer also typically provides instructions, e.g., to the heating/cooling component and autofocus system, etc.
  • Any controller or computer optionally includes a monitor, which is often a cathode ray tube ("CRT") display, a flat panel display (e.g., active matrix liquid crystal display, liquid crystal display), or the like.
  • a monitor which is often a cathode ray tube ("CRT") display, a flat panel display (e.g., active matrix liquid crystal display, liquid crystal display), or the like.
  • Data produced from the current systems, e.g., nucleic acid sequence results is optionally displayed in electronic form on the monitor.
  • the data e.g., light emission profiles from the nucleic acid arrays, or other data, gathered from the system can be outputted in printed form.
  • the data whether in printed form or electronic form (e.g., as displayed on a monitor), can be in various or multiple formats, e.g., curves, histograms, numeric series, tables, graphs and the like.
  • Computer circuitry is often placed in a box which includes, e.g., numerous integrated circuit chips, such as a microprocessor, memory, interface circuits.
  • the box also optionally includes a hard disk drive, a floppy disk drive, a high capacity removable drive such as a writeable CD-ROM, and other common peripheral elements.
  • Inputting devices such as a keyboard or mouse optionally provide for input from a user and for user selection of sequences to be compared or otherwise manipulated in the relevant computer system.
  • the SBS systems herein comprise CCD/TIRF laser based excitation and imaging subsystems which can image millions of nucleic acid clusters per sample (typically within a flowcell) and which can detect each of four fluorescent dyes (one for each of the four bases).
  • the SBS chemistry components e.g., nucleotides, WO04018497 , WO04018493 and US7057026 , polymerases WO05024010 and WO06120433 , surface attachment techniques, WO05065814 , cluster preparation and sequencing, WO 9844151 , WO06064199 and WO07010251 , are compatible with the channeled flowcell components herein, etc.
  • the computer or data analysis system aspects of the system are optionally capable of processing thousands of images per hour into sequence information
  • genomic DNA is randomly fragmented, end capped with known sequences, and covalently attached to a substrate (such as the channel in a flowcell), e.g., by hybridization to a covalent primer.
  • a substrate such as the channel in a flowcell
  • SBS analysis e.g., using the systems and devices herein
  • SBS analysis can generate a series of images of the clusters, which can then be processed to read the sequence of the nucleic acids in each cluster which can then be aligned against a reference sequence to determine sequence differences, a larger overall sequence, or the like.
  • Algorithms for the alignment of short reads of nucleic acids are described in WO05068089 .
  • each sequencing cycle will include a round of incorporation onto the growing nucleic acid chain. Such cycle is typically done by an addition of all four dNTPs, each modified so that each base is identifiable by a unique fluorophore. Additionally, the triphosphates are modified at the 3' position so that extension is controlled and not more than a single base can be added to each molecule in each cycle.
  • the generic concept of performing clusters amplified from a single template molecule on a random array, and the subsequent sequencing of said array is shown in Figures 30-32 , which schematically illustrate various aspects of sequencing procedures and methods carried out by the systems herein.
  • Figure 30 shows the basic outlines of nucleic acid cluster creation and sequencing while Figure 31 compares nucleic acid density between an array (on left) and on a nucleic acid cluster substrate such as those capable of use with the systems/devices of the invention (on right).
  • Figure 32 gives a cartoon outlining the SBS sequencing procedure, e.g., as done by embodiments of the invention.
  • the channels of the flowcell are washed out by the fluid flow subsystem in order to remove any unincorporated nucleosides and enzyme.
  • a read step is performed by the system, whereby the identity of the individual labels (read as a group in each cluster) incorporated in the incorporation step is recorded using optical microscopy and the corresponding base incorporated is noted.
  • the sequencing system can read the four different fluorophores using two lasers at distinct wavelengths via total internal reflection microscopy (TIRF) and four distinct emission filters at different parts of the spectrum. The images are recorded onto a CCD camera and reported into the attached computer module.
  • TIRF total internal reflection microscopy
  • a deprotection step removes the labeling moiety and block from the surface bound DNA.
  • the deprotection allows repetition of the above incorporation and reading steps until sufficient cycles of information are obtained to uniquely place the sequence of each nucleic acid cluster (present on the flowcell) in its genomic context. For example, in the case of the human genome this will be >16 cycles, e.g., about 25-50 cycles.
  • the images can be stored off line, or processed in real time such that the individual bases are read during the sequencing process. Processing the images provides a database of a sequence read from every cluster, where each cluster is derived from a random position somewhere in entire sample (e.g., a genome).
  • a database of millions of sequence reads covering every part of the genome is typically constructed.
  • Such database can be, e.g., compared with a database of every sequence derived from a reference sequence, etc.
  • image analysis, sequence determination, and/or sequence alignment are optionally performed "off-line" after the fluorescent images are captured.
  • Such procedures are also optionally performed by a computer separate from the one present in the current systems.
  • the components can comprise: illumination lasers (used to excite the fluorophores in the sequencing reactions) of 532 and 660 nm each with 75 mW power (or optionally greater) that project as 0.5 mm circle on the bottom of the channel in a flowcell; a TIR prism of glass (68 deg or 71 deg); a glass flowcell with channels of 1 ⁇ 61 mm area having 8 channels that are 100 ⁇ m deep (39x1 mm usable or accessible for viewing); an objective lens in the camera component comprising a Nikon Plan Apo 20x, 0.75NA (corrected for glass thickness); emission filters comprising Bandpass filters of 557 ⁇ 11 nm, 615 ⁇ 40 nm, 684 ⁇ 11 nm, and 740 ⁇ 50nm (or optionally filters as shown, or similar to those shown, in Figure 22 );
  • Such 1 Megapixel embodiments can illuminate a 0.5 mm circle and detect a 0.35 mm square inside it.
  • the flowcell in such embodiments can have a total of 156 non-overlapping tiles in a channel or higher.
  • the clusters can be on the order of 1 ⁇ m.
  • the NA of the microscope can optionally give a PSF of approximately 0.6 ⁇ m at 700 nm.
  • a "typical" cluster gets an apparent diameter of approximately 1.2 ⁇ m.
  • 1 pixel represents approximately 0.35 ⁇ m, so a typical cluster would have about 3.5 pixels diameter.
  • the area of a cluster is the about 9.25 pixels. Poisson distribution of 10 area pixel objects on 1 Mpixel CCD shows maximum of about 38,000 objects will be non-overlapping as shown in Figure 29.
  • Figure 29 gives an example of information throughput from an exemplary configuration of a system of the invention.
  • the number of detected clusters is a function of the total cluster number and the minimum cluster area.
  • the resolution limit (using Rayleigh criterion) is about 0.6 ⁇ m and clusters are about 1 ⁇ m for an apparent size of about 1.2 ⁇ m. Pixels map to about 0.35 ⁇ m in image plane so a cluster is about 3.5 pixels across and about 10 pixels in area. For randomly distributed clusters, the maximum number of unconfused clusters in the 1 MPix camera will be about 38,000 in a 0.35 mm square tile.
  • "b" flowcells accommodate 150 non-overlapping illumination tiles per channel for a total of 1200 tiles per flowcell. This is 45.6 M Bases per cycle and about 1 GBase in a 25 cycle run. Overlapping the illumination and closely packing the tiles means that 200 tiles can be imaged per channel, and therefore 1600 per flowcell.
  • the laser wavelengths are: green laser wavelength 532 nm; green laser power optionally 75 mW; red laser wavelength 660 nm; red laser power optionally 75 mW; projected TIRF beam diameter 0.5 mm; and allowed variation across beam 20%.
  • the system of the invention can comprise: illumination lasers of 532 and 660 nm, each with 500 mW power (ideally projected as 0.5 mm square), a TIR prism of glass (68 deg); a glass flowcell having 8 channels 100 ⁇ m deep and of 1 ⁇ 61 mm in area with a 50 mm usable; an objective lens comprising a Nikon Plan Fluor 40x, 0.6 NA adjustable collar, or custom 40x, 0.75 NA corrected for an SBS flowcell; emission filters comprising Bandpass filters of 557 ⁇ 11 nm, 615 ⁇ 40 nm, 684 ⁇ 11 nm, and 740 ⁇ 50 nm; image optics comprising an 150 mm achromatic doublet for system magnification of 30x; and a digital CCD camera comprising a Photometries CoolSNAP K4, 2048 by 2048 pixels, 4Mpix camera, 7.4 ⁇ m pixel size, 20 MHz readout.
  • illumination lasers of 532 and 660 nm each with 500 mW power
  • a 0.5 mm square is uniformly illuminated and that the same 0.5 mm square is detected (2048 ⁇ 7.4 / 30000).
  • the clusters on the flowcells herein can be as small as 0.5 ⁇ m.
  • PSF at 700 nm is approximately 0.7 ⁇ m.
  • Clusters thus appear as 0.86 ⁇ m where 1 pixel represents 0.25 ⁇ m.
  • a typical cluster therefore is 3.5 pixels and the area of a cluster is 9.25 pixels.
  • 4 Mpixel CCD gives a maximum of about 135,000 detectable non-overlapping clusters per tile.
  • the illumination footprint is four times larger, meaning a 4 time increase in laser powers is needed to obtain the same level of signal in the same exposure time. To minimize exposure times, the laser power can be increased further.
  • the instrument can be configured to perform multiple chemistry steps with multiple fluidics systems coupled to a single optical system. In the single chemistry system, the optical system is not imaging whilst the chemistry steps are occurring. If the chemistry and imaging parts of the cycle take similar lengths, then for 50% of the time, the instrument is not recording data.
  • TDI Time Delay Integration
  • the system as described is shown with the illumination from underneath, and the objective on top, the system as shown can be inverted to illuminate from the top, and have the detection system underneath. See above.
  • the heating and illumination can be carried out from either face of the substrate, so that bottom side heating and top side illumination are also within the scope of the invention.
  • the operation of systems within the scope of the inventions are further described in the following general methods.
  • the solid supports used for attachment of nucleic acid to be sequenced are optionally 8-channel glass chips such as those provided by Silex Microsystems (Sweden). However, the experimental conditions and procedures are readily applicable to other solid supports as well. In some embodiments chips were washed as follows: neat Decon for 30 min, milliQ H2O for 30 min, NaOH IN for 15 min, milliQ H2O for 30 min, HCl 0.1N for 15 min, milliQ H2O for 30 min. The Polymer solution preparation entailed: For 10 ml of 2% polymerization mix.
  • the 10 ml solution of acrylamide was first degassed with argon for 15 min.
  • the solutions of BRAPA, TEMED and potassium persulfate were successively added to the acrylamide solution.
  • the mixture was then quickly vortexed and immediately used. Polymerization was then carried out for 1h 30 at RT. Afterwards the channels were washed with milliQ H2O for 30 min and filled with 0.1 M potassium phosphate buffer for storage until required.
  • N-Boc-1,5-diaminopentane toluene sulfonic acid was obtained from Novabiochem.
  • the bromoacetyl chloride and acryloyl chloride were obtained from Fluka. All other reagents were Aldrich products.
  • a peristaltic pump Ismatec IPC equipped with tubing Ismatec Ref 070534-051 (orange/yellow, 0.51 mm internal diameter) is optionally used.
  • the pump is run in the forward direction (pulling fluids).
  • a waste dish is installed to collect used solution at the outlet of the peristaltic pump tubing.
  • the different solutions used are dispensed into 8 tube microtube strips, using 1 tube per chip inlet tubing, in order to monitor the correct pumping of the solutions in each channel. The volume required per channel is specified for each step.
  • the Silex chip is mounted on top of an MJ-Research thermocycler.
  • the chip sits on top of a custom made copper block, which is attached to the flat heating block of the thermocycler.
  • the chip is covered with a small Perspex block and is held in place by adhesive tape. Both pump and thermocycler are controlled by computer run scripts, which prompt the user to change solutions between each step.
  • An SFA coated chip is placed onto a modified MJ-Research thermocycler and attached to a peristaltic pump as described above. Grafting mix consisting of 0.5 ⁇ M of a forward primer and 0.5 ⁇ M of a reverse primer in 10 mM phosphate buffer (pH 7.0) is pumped into the channels of the chip at a flow rate of 60 ⁇ l/min for 75 s at 20 °C. The thermocycler is then heated up to 51.6 °C, and the chip is incubated at this temperature for 1 hour.
  • the grafting mix undergoes 18 cycles of pumping: grafting mix is pumped in at 15 ⁇ l/min for 20 s, then the solution is pumped back and forth (5 s forward at 15 ⁇ l/min, then 5 s backward at 15 ⁇ l/min) for 180 s. After 18 cycles of pumping, the chip is washed by pumping in 5xSSC/5mM EDTA at 15 ⁇ l/min for 300 s at 51.6 °C. The thermocycler is then cooled to 20 °C.
  • the DNA templates to be hybridized to the grafted chip are diluted to the required concentration (currently 0.5-2pM) in 5 ⁇ SSC/0.1% Tween.
  • the diluted DNA is heated on a heating block at 100 °C for 5 min to denature the double stranded DNA into single strands suitable for hybridization.
  • the DNA is then immediately snap-chilled in an ice/water bath for 3 min.
  • the tubes containing the DNA are briefly spun in a centrifuge to collect any condensation, and then transferred to a pre-chilled 8-tube strip and used immediately.
  • the grafted chip from above is primed by pumping in 5 ⁇ SSC/0.1% Tween at 60 ⁇ l/min for 75 s at 20 °C.
  • the thermocycler is then heated to 98.5 °C, and the denatured DNA is pumped in at 15 ⁇ l/min for 300 s.
  • An additional pump at 100 ⁇ l/min for 10 s is carried out to flush through bubbles formed by the heating of the hybridization mix.
  • the temperature is then held at 98.5 °C for 30 s, before being cooled slowly to 40.2 °C over 19.5 min.
  • the chip is then washed by pumping in 0.3 ⁇ SSC/0.1% Tween at 15 ⁇ l/min for 300 s at 40.2 °C.
  • the script then runs straight to the next step.
  • the hybridized template molecules are amplified by a bridging polymerase chain reaction using the grafted primers and a thermostable polymerase.
  • Amplification buffer consisting of 10 mM Tris (pH 9.0), 50 mM KCI, 1.5 mM MgC12, 1 M betaine and 1.3% DMSO is pumped into the chip at 15 p,l/min for 200 s at 40.2 °C.
  • amplification mix of the above buffer supplemented with 200 ⁇ M dNTPs and 25 U/ml Taq polymerase is pumped in at 60 ⁇ l/min for 75 s at 40.2 °C.
  • the thermocycler is then heated to 74 °C and held at this temperature for 90 s.
  • thermocycler then carries out 50 cycles of amplification by heating to 98.5 °C for 45 s (denaturation of bridged strands), 58 °C for 90 s (annealing of strands to surface primers) and 74 °C for 90 s (primer extension).
  • 98.5 °C fresh PCR mix is pumped into the channels of the chip at 15 ⁇ l/min for 10 s.
  • this step also removes DNA strands and primers which have become detached from the surface and which could lead to contamination between clusters.
  • thermocycling the chip is cooled to 20 °C.
  • the chip is then washed by pumping in 0.3 ⁇ SSC/0.1% Tween at 15 ⁇ l/min for 300 s at 74 °C.
  • the thermocycler is then cooled to 20 °C.
  • Linearization mix consisting of 0.1 M sodium periodate and 0.1 M ethanolamine is pumped into the chip at 15 ⁇ l/min for 1 hr at 20 °C. The chip is then washed by pumping in water at 15 ⁇ l/min for 300 s at 20 °C.
  • This step uses Terminal Transferase to incorporate a dideoxynucleotide onto the free 3' OH ends of DNA strands (both grafted primers and amplified cluster molecules).
  • Blocking buffer consisting of 50 mM potassium acetate, 20 mM Tris-acetate, 10 mM magnesium acetate, 1 mM dithiothreitol (pH 7.9) and 250 ⁇ M CoCl2 is pumped into the chip at 15 ⁇ l/min for 200 s at 20 °C.
  • Blocking Mix of the above buffer supplemented with 2.4 ⁇ M ddNTPs and 250 U/ml Terminal transferase is pumped in at 15 ⁇ l/min for 300 s at 37.7 °C.
  • the thermocycler is held at 37.7 °C for 30 min, during which time Blocking Mix is pumped into the chip at 15 ⁇ l/min for 20 s every 3 min.
  • the chip is then washed by pumping in 0.3 ⁇ SSC/0.1% Tween at 15 ⁇ l/min for 300 s at 20 °C.
  • This step uses NaOH to denature and wash away one of the strands of the amplified, linearized and blocked clusters. After a wash to remove the NaOH, the sequencing primer is then hybridized onto the single strands left on the surface.
  • the double stranded DNA in the clusters is denatured by pumping in 0.1N NaOH at 15 ⁇ l/min for 300 s at 20 °C.
  • the chip is then washed by pumping in TE (10 mM Tris pH 8.0, 1 mM EDTA) at 15 ⁇ l/min for 300 s at 20 °C.
  • Sequencing primer is diluted to 0.5 ⁇ M in 5 ⁇ SSC/0.1% Tween, and pumped into the channels at 15 ⁇ l/min for 300 s at 20 °C.
  • the thermocycler is then heated up to 60 °C and held at this temperature for 15 min.
  • the thermocycler is then cooled to 40.2 °C and the chip is washed by pumping in 0.3xSSC/0.1% Tween at 15 ⁇ l/min for 300 s.
  • the clusters are now ready for 1st cycle sequencing enzymology, e.g., with the systems and devices of the current invention.
  • the DNA sequence used in this process was a single monotemplate sequence of 400 bases, with ends complimentary to the grafted primers.
  • the duplex DNA was denatured as described above.
  • the primers are typically 5'-phosphorothioate oligonucleotides incorporating any specific sequences or modifications required for cleavage. Their sequences and suppliers vary according to the experiment they are to be used for, and in this case were complementary to the 5'-ends of the template duplex.
  • the amplified clusters contained a diol linkage in one of the grafted primers.
  • Diol linkages can be introduced by including a suitable linkage into one of the primers used for solid-phase amplification.
  • Suitable primers including any desired template-specific sequence can be manufactured by standard automated DNA synthesis techniques using components available from commercial suppliers (e.g. Fidelity Systems Inc., ATD).
  • a cleavable diol-containing primer would typically have the following structure: 5' -phosphorothioate-arm 26-diol22A-sequence-3' OH.
  • sequence represents a sequence of nucleotides capable of hybridizing to the template to be amplified.
  • the structures of the arm26 and diol22A components are as follows: Products containing such diol linkages can be cleaved using periodate as described above, and the resulting single stranded polynucleotides hybridized as described above.
  • a mutant 9°N polymerase enzyme (an exo- variant including the triple mutation L408Y/Y409A/P410V and C223S) was used for the nucleotide incorporation steps.
  • Incorporation mix Incorporation buffer (50 mM Tris-HCl pH 8.0, 6 mM MgSO4, 1 mM EDTA, 0.05% (v/v) Tween -20, 50mM NaCl) plus 110nM YAV exo-C223S, and 1 ⁇ M each of the four labeled modified nucleotides, was applied to the clustered templates, and heated to 45°C.
  • Incorporation buffer 50 mM Tris-HCl pH 8.0, 6 mM MgSO4, 1 mM EDTA, 0.05% (v/v) Tween -20, 50mM NaCl
  • 110nM YAV exo-C223S 1 ⁇ M each of the four labeled modified nucleotides
  • Templates were maintained at 45°C for 30min, cooled to 20°C and washed with Incorporation buffer, then with 5x SSC/0.05% Tween 20. Templates were then exposed to Imaging buffer(100mM Tris pH7.0, 30mM NaCl, 0.05% Tween 20, 50mM sodium ascorbate, freshly dissolved).
  • Templates were scanned in 4 colors at RT.
  • the flowcell can be sequenced in a fully automated way, with the first incorporation being performed on this instrument, as described below:
  • the templates can be exposed to the sequencing cycles described below : first base incorporation, imaging then alternating cleavage, imaging and incorporation, imaging steps for as many sequencing cycles as required.
  • Each tile of each the chip for the non-fully automated process above was recorded in each of the four colors corresponding to the labeled nucleotides.
  • the images were analyzed to pick the brightest color for each cluster, and this image intensity analysis was used to call the base for each cluster at each cycle. Images from each cycle were co-localized to obtain the sequence corresponding to each cluster.
  • the error rates i.e. clusters not called as the correct sequence
  • the error rates were less than 1% for the first 20 cycles of the experiment, meaning the known sequence of the monotemplate was correctly called.

Landscapes

  • Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Life Sciences & Earth Sciences (AREA)
  • Organic Chemistry (AREA)
  • Proteomics, Peptides & Aminoacids (AREA)
  • Analytical Chemistry (AREA)
  • General Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Zoology (AREA)
  • Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
  • Immunology (AREA)
  • Biochemistry (AREA)
  • Wood Science & Technology (AREA)
  • Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • General Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
  • Microbiology (AREA)
  • Pathology (AREA)
  • Dispersion Chemistry (AREA)
  • General Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Biotechnology (AREA)
  • Genetics & Genomics (AREA)
  • Nuclear Medicine, Radiotherapy & Molecular Imaging (AREA)
  • Molecular Biology (AREA)
  • Biophysics (AREA)
  • Bioinformatics & Cheminformatics (AREA)
  • Clinical Laboratory Science (AREA)
  • Chemical Kinetics & Catalysis (AREA)
  • Hematology (AREA)
  • Apparatus Associated With Microorganisms And Enzymes (AREA)
  • Investigating, Analyzing Materials By Fluorescence Or Luminescence (AREA)
  • Measuring Or Testing Involving Enzymes Or Micro-Organisms (AREA)
  • Investigating Or Analysing Materials By The Use Of Chemical Reactions (AREA)

Abstract

The present invention comprises systems and devices for sequencing of nucleic acid, such as short DNA sequences from clonally amplified single-molecule arrays.

Description

    FIELD OF THE INVENTION
  • The current invention relates to the field of nucleic acid sequencing. More specifically, the present invention provides systems and devices for sequence analysis of nucleic acids such as short DNA sequences from clonally amplified single-molecule arrays.
  • CROSS-REFERENCE TO RELATED APPLICATIONS
  • The present application claims priority to USSN 60/788,248 filed March 31, 2006 and USSN 60/795,368 filed April 26, 2006 , each of which is herein incorporated by reference in its entirety for all purposes.
  • BACKGROUND OF THE INVENTION
  • Numerous recent advances in the study of biology have benefited from improved methods of analysis and sequencing of nucleic acids. For example, the Human Genome Project has determined the entire sequence of the human genome which is hoped to lead to further discoveries in fields ranging from treatment of disease to advances in basic science. While the "human genome" has been sequenced there are still vast amounts of genomic material to analyze, e.g., genetic variation between different individuals, tissues, additional species, etc.
  • Devices for DNA sequencing based on separation of fragments of differing length were first developed in the 1980s, and have been commercially available for a number of years. However, such technology involves running individual samples through capillary columns filled with polyacrylamide gels and is thus limited in throughput due to the time taken to run each sample. A number of new DNA sequencing technologies have recently been reported that are based on the massively parallel analysis of unamplified ( WO00006770 ; Proceedings of the National Academy of Sciences U.S.A, 100, 3960-3964 (2003)) or amplified single molecules, either in the form of planar arrays ( WO9844151 ) or on beads ( WO04069849 ; Nature, 437, 376-380 (2005); Science, 309, 5741, 1728-1732 (2005); Nat Biotechnol. 6, 630-6344 (2000)).
  • The methodology used to analyze the sequence of the nucleic acids in such new sequencing techniques is often based on the detection of fluorescent nucleotides or oligonucleotides. The detection instrumentation used to read the fluorescence signals on such arrays is usually based on either epifluorescence or total internal reflection microscopy, for example as described in WO9641011 , WO00006770 or WO02072892 . Whilst total internal reflection microscopy has been used to image both single and amplified molecules of DNA on surfaces, a robust, reliable, four color DNA sequencing platform (e.g., comprising heating systems, fluidic controls, uniform illumination, control of the optical beam shape, an autofocus system, and full software control of all components) is described herein for the first time.
  • There is a continuing need for better, more robust, and more economical devices and systems for fast reliable sequencing of nucleic acids. The current invention provides these and other benefits which will be apparent upon examination of the current specification, claims, and figures.
  • SUMMARY OF THE INVENTION
  • In various aspects herein, the invention comprises systems and devices for sequencing one or more polynucleotide. The systems can be used to image planar substrates, wherein the substrates can comprise unamplified single molecules, amplified single molecules, one or more collections of arrayed beads, or various combinations thereof. When used for sequencing, the systems can optionally comprise a planar solid substrate having one or more polynucleotides displayed thereon, e.g. either directly attached, or attached to beads that are optionally arrayed on the substrate; a fluid direction system that controllably moves various reagents (e.g., buffers, enzymes, fluorescently labeled nucleotides or oligonucleotides, etc.) into contact with the polynucleotides; a temperature control system that regulates the temperature of the substrate and/or of the reagents; an optical system for obtaining total internal reflection illumination of the substrate with a uniform beam footprint (where the shape of the footprint is optionally controlled), a light source (e.g., one comprising one or more lasers) for exciting the fluorescent moiet(ies); a detector component (e.g., a CCD camera and objective lenses, etc.) that is proximal to the substrate and which captures and detects fluorescence from the excited moiet(ies); a computer, connected to the detector, which has instruction sets for controlling the various components of the system, acquiring fluorescence data from the detector and optionally for determining sequence of the polynucleotide from the fluorescence data.
  • In some such embodiments, the substrates can be moved away from the detector in order to interact with the temperature control system, thus, regulating the temperature of the substrate (e.g., to allow polymerase reactions to proceed, etc.). In such embodiments, the system can comprise a scanning stage or moving platform that is optionally computer controlled. The heating device can be a computer controlled Peltier device or other heating/cooling component that moves in relation to the scanning stage, or the stage can optionally move to ensure that the Peltier is in contact with the substrate.
  • In the various embodiments herein, the substrate can comprise a flowcell. Flowcells can have one or more fluidic channel in which the polynucleotide is displayed (e.g., wherein the polynucleotides are directly attached to the flowcell or wherein the polynucleotides are attached to one or more beads arrayed upon the flowcell) and can be comprised of glass, silicon, plastic, or various combinations thereof.
  • In typical embodiments, the reagents include components to synthesize a second sequence complementary to the one or more polynucleotides. The synthesis can be performed using labeled nucleotides, which can be added individually or as a mixture of nucleotides, or as labeled oligonucleotides. In the case of labeled oligonucleotides, the identity of one or more bases complementary to the labeled oligonucleotide can be determined. The labeled nucleotides can take the form of fluorescently labeled triphosphates, which can contain a blocking moiety to control the addition and ensure a single nucleotide is added to each polynucleotide. The fluorophore can be attached to the blocking moiety, which can be located at the 3' position of the sugar, or can be attached through the nucleotide base through a linker that can optionally be cleaved using the same conditions as removal of the blocking moiety. The linker and blocking moiety may be cleaved using the same reagents.
  • In various embodiments herein, the Total Internal Reflection (TIRF) system can comprise, e.g., a lamp or a laser. The system can comprise more than one excitation lasers that can be coupled through a fiberoptic device. Such lasers can illuminate at least part of the same area. (i.e., overlap). The TIRF lasers herein also optionally comprise a shaking, vibrating, waveplate modulated, or piezo-electric actuator squeezed fiber mode scrambler to make the optical intensity substantially uniform over an entire illumination footprint of the laser. A number of mechanisms for controlling the illumination intensity and uniformity are described herein. The shape of the fiber also can be used to control the shape of the illumination footprint.
  • The detector component in the various embodiments herein can comprise one or more objective lenses, additional tube lenses, an autofocus system that adjusts either the stage position and/or the position of the objective lens(es) to ensure the substrate remains in focus, optical filter(s) appropriate to transmit the emission wavelength of the fluorophores and block the light from the excitation source, and a system for recording the fluorescence emission from the fluorophores, for example a charge coupled device (CCD) or similar camera.
  • These and other features of the invention will become more fully apparent when the following detailed description is read in conjunction with the accompanying figures and claims.
  • BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE DRAWINGS
    • Figure 1 , displays a generalized overview of the major components of an exemplary system of the invention.
    • Figure 2 , displays a photograph of an exemplary system of the invention shown without an enclosing chassis or covering.
    • Figure 3 , displays a photograph of an exemplary flowcell, lens objective, and fiber optic laser arrangement within a system of the invention.
    • Figure 4 , Panels A-D show exemplary configurations of flowcells.
    • Figure 5 , Panels A and B, show one method of forming a flowcell of the system (Panel A) and a transmission spectra of Foturan glass (Panel B).
    • Figure 6 , Panels A-E show an exemplary possible etching method to construct flowcells herein.
    • Figure 7 , Panels A-C present exemplary schematic diagrams of possible fluid flow components/arrangements of the system in push (Panel A) or pull (Panels B and C) configurations.
    • Figure 8 , shows an exemplary heating/cooling component of the system in isolation from other aspects of the invention.
    • Figure 9 , panels A-D present schematic diagrams of possible flowcell and flowcell holder configurations of the invention.
    • Figure 10 , Panels A and B present photographs of an exemplary embodiment of the invention showing movement of the heating/cooling component and the flowcell holder (Panel A) and a schematic of the heating/cooling components in relation to other components of an exemplary system (Panel B).
    • Figure 11 , Panels A and B show schematics displaying an exemplary framework holding the optics, fiber optic laser mount, heating/cooling, and flowcell holder components (A); and an exemplary flowcell leveling adjustment configuration (B).
    • Figure 12 , presents a picture of an exemplary embodiment of the system showing framework and housing of the system.
    • Figures 13 -16 , present various optional configurations of cameras, light sources, and other components in the systems herein.
    • Figures 17-19 , show various schematics for beam shape and dimensions for TIRF lasers in various embodiments of the systems herein.
    • Figure 20 , displays an optional embodiment of a TIRF prism for use with the systems and devices herein.
    • Figure 21 , illustrates creation of a square laser beam by polishing the end of a multimode fiber output.
    • Figure 22 , Panels A and B,, illustrate an exemplary filters and filter wheel configuration optionally within various embodiments herein (A), as well as the spectrum of those filters in relation to four exemplary fluorophores excited at the laser wavelengths (B).
    • Figure 23 , illustrates an exemplary nominal 1G design, 30X K4 System Ray trace of the optic components of a system of the invention.
    • Figure 24 , shows the 30X K4 imaging performance of an exemplary system of the invention.
    • Figure 25 , presents a schematic diagram of an autofocusing feature of an exemplary system herein.
    • Figures 26-27 , display photographs of focused and unfocused measurements made by various embodiments of the systems/devices herein.
    • Figure 28 , presents a diagram of an autofocus laser beam.
    • Figure 29 , shows a graph of the number of detected nucleic acid clusters as a function of total cluster number and minimum cluster area as detected by an embodiment of the invention.
    • Figures 30-32 , display outlines of nucleic acid clusters and their sequencing with the systems/devices of the invention.
    • Figure 33 , Panels A-D show the effects of three different forms of physical . deformation to a circular optical fiber on the beam emerging from the fiber. Vibrating or squeezing the fiber makes the light emerging from the fiber uniform over the integration time of the image.
    • Figure 34 , Panels A-D show the effects of three different forms of physical deformation to a rectangular optical fiber on the beam emerging from the fiber. Vibrating or squeezing the fiber makes the light emerging from the fiber uniform over the integration time of the image.
    • Figure 35 , Panels A-L display the effects of various mode scrambling schemes on emergent light from a number of different optical fibers.
    • Figure 36 shows one possible arrangement for a dual camera system embodiment of the invention.
    • Figure 37 shows an exemplary embodiment of the invention containing 2 cameras for simultaneous recording of 2 colors on the same image.
    • Figure 38 , shows a schematic of a λ/2 waveplate.
    • Figure 39 , shows a schematic of a λ/2 modified waveplate comprising a number of differently orientated sections.
    • Figure 40 , shows an outline of a mode waveplate modulated mixing system of an embodiment of the invention.
    • Figure 41 , Panels A-D show photographs of an illuminated footprint area from a multimode optical fiber and results from mixing of optical modes through use of waveplates.
    • Figure 42 , Panels A and B display the substantial uniformity of a laser footprint area from multimode mixing through use of waveplates.
    • Figure 43 shows a dual flowcell holder embodiment of the invention such that chemistry operations can be performed in parallel in order to maximize the scanning time of the instrument.
    • Figure 44 , Panels A-F show exemplary embodiments of bottom flow flowcells, prisms, and side/top TIRF illumination
    • Figure 45 shows an exemplary temperature regulation component beneath a flowcell and prism.
    • Figure 46 shows an exemplary fluidic valve and exemplary manifolds (e.g., for use with bottom flow flowcells.
    • Figure 47 shows an exemplary fluidic valve of the invention.
    • Figure 48 , Panels A and B show one possible dual flowcell configuration of the invention.
    • Figure 49 , Panels A-F show various exemplary bottom temperature regulation configurations capable of use with bottom flow flowcells of the invention.
    DETAILED DESCRIPTION
  • The present invention comprises systems and devices to analyze a large number of different nucleic acid sequences from, e.g., clonally amplified single-molecule DNA arrays in flowcells, or from an array of immobilized beads. The systems herein are optionally useful in, e.g., sequencing for comparative genomics (such as for genotyping, SNP discovery, BAC-end sequencing, chromosome breakpoint mapping, and whole genome sequence assembly), tracking gene expression, micro RNA sequence analysis, epigenomics (e.g., with methylation mapping DNAsel hypersensitive site mapping or chromatin immunoprecipitation), and aptamer and phage display library characterization. Of course, those of skill in the art will readily appreciate that the current invention is also amenable to use for myriad other sequencing applications. The systems herein comprise various combinations of optical, mechanical, fluidic, thermal, electrical, and computing devices/aspects which are described more fully below. Also, even though in certain embodiments the invention is directed towards particular configurations and/or combinations of such aspects, those of skill in the art will appreciate that not all embodiments necessarily comprise all aspects or particular configurations (unless specifically stated to do so).
  • In brief, the general aspects of the invention are outlined in Figure 1 which shows an exemplary TIRF imaging configuration of a backlight design embodiment. As can be seen in Figure 1, fluid delivery module or device 100 directs the flow of reagents (e.g., fluorescent nucleotides, buffers, enzymes, cleavage reagents, etc.) to (and through) flowcell 110 and waste valve 120. In particular embodiments, the flowcell comprises clusters of nucleic acid sequences (e.g., of about 200-1000 bases in length) to be sequenced which are optionally attached to the substrate of the flowcell, as well as optionally other components. The flowcell can also comprise an array of beads, where each bead optionally contains multiple copies of a single sequence. The preparation of such beads can be performed according to a variety of techniques, for example as described in USPN 6,172,218 or WO04069849 (Bead emulsion nucleic acid amplification).
  • The system also comprises temperature station actuator 130 and heater/cooler 135, which can optionally regulate the temperature of conditions of the fluids within the flowcell. As explained below, various embodiments can comprise different configurations of the heating/cooling components. The flowcell is monitored, and sequencing is tracked, by camera system 140 (e.g., a CCD camera) which can interact with various filters within filter switching assembly 145, lens objective 142, and focusing laser/focusing laser assembly 150. Laser device 160 (e.g., an excitation laser within an assembly optionally comprising multiple lasers) acts to illuminate fluorescent sequencing reactions within the flowcell via laser illumination through fiber optic 161 (which can optionally comprise one or more re-imaging lenses, a fiber optic mounting, etc. Low watt lamp 165, mirror 180 and reverse dichroic 185 are also presented in the embodiment shown. See below. Additionally, mounting stage 170, allows for proper alignment and movement of the flowcell, temperature actuator, camera, etc. in relation to the various components of the invention. Focus (z-axis) component 175 can also aid in manipulation and positioning of various components (e.g., a lens objective). Such components are optionally organized upon a framework and/or enclosed within a housing structure. It will be appreciated that the illustrations herein are of exemplary embodiments and are not necessarily to be taken as limiting. Thus, for example, different embodiments can comprise different placement of components relative to one another (e.g., embodiment A comprises a heater/cooler as in Figure 1, while embodiment B comprises a heater/cooler component beneath its flowcell, etc.).
  • Definitions
  • Before describing the present invention in detail, it is to be understood that the invention herein is not limited to use with particular nucleic acids or biological systems, which can, of course, vary. It is also to be understood that the terminology used herein is for the purpose of describing particular embodiments only, and is not intended to be limiting. As used in this specification and the appended claims, the singular forms "a," "an," and "the" include plural referents unless the context clearly dictates otherwise. Thus, for example, reference to "a flowcell" optionally includes a combination of two or more flowcells, and the like.
  • As used herein, the terms "polynucleotide" or "nucleic acids" refer to deoxyribonucleic acid (DNA), but where appropriate the skilled artisan will recognize that the systems and devices herein can also be utilized with ribonucleic acid (RNA). The terms should be understood to include, as equivalents, analogs of either DNA or RNA made from nucleotide analogs. The terms as used herein also encompasses cDNA, that is complementary, or copy, DNA produced from an RNA template, for example by the action of reverse transcriptase.
  • The single stranded polynucleotide molecules sequenced by the systems and devices herein can have originated in single-stranded form, as DNA or RNA or have originated in double-stranded DNA (dsDNA) form (e.g. genomic DNA fragments, PCR and amplification products and the like). Thus a single stranded polynucleotide may be the sense or antisense strand of a polynucleotide duplex. Methods of preparation of single stranded polynucleotide molecules suitable for use in the method of the invention using standard techniques are well known in the art. The precise sequence of the primary polynucleotide molecules is generally not material to the invention, and may be known or unknown. The single stranded polynucleotide molecules can represent genomic DNA molecules (e.g., human genomic DNA) including both intron and exon sequences (coding sequence), as well as non-coding regulatory sequences such as promoter and enhancer sequences.
  • In certain embodiments, the nucleic acid to be sequenced through use of the current invention is immobilized upon a substrate (e.g., a substrate within a flowcell or one or more beads upon a substrate such as a flowcell, etc.). The term "immobilized" as used herein is intended to encompass direct or indirect, covalent or non-covalent attachment, unless indicated otherwise, either explicitly or by context. In certain embodiments of the invention covalent attachment may be preferred, but generally all that is required is that the molecules (e.g. nucleic acids) remain immobilized or attached to the support under conditions in which it is intended to use the support, for example in applications requiring nucleic acid sequencing.
  • The term "solid support" (or "substrate" in certain usages) as used herein refers to any inert substrate or matrix to which nucleic acids can be attached, such as for example glass surfaces, plastic surfaces, latex, dextran, polystyrene surfaces, polypropylene surfaces, polyacrylamide gels, gold surfaces, and silicon wafers. In many embodiments, the solid support is a glass surface (e.g., the planar surface of a flowcell channel). In certain embodiments the solid support may comprise an inert substrate or matrix which has been "functionalized," for example by the application of a layer or coating of an intermediate material comprising reactive groups which permit covalent attachment to molecules such as polynucleotides. By way of non-limiting example such supports can include polyacrylamide hydrogels supported on an inert substrate such as glass. In such embodiments the molecules (polynucleotides) can be directly covalently attached to the intermediate material (e.g. the hydrogel) but the intermediate material can itself be non-covalently attached to the substrate or matrix (e.g. the glass substrate). Covalent attachment to a solid support is to be interpreted accordingly as encompassing this type of arrangement.
  • System Overview
  • As indicated above, the present invention comprises novel systems and devices for sequencing nucleic acids. As will be apparent to those of skill in the art, references herein to a particular nucleic acid sequence may, depending on the context, also refer to nucleic acid molecules which comprise such nucleic acid sequence. Sequencing of a target fragment means that a read of the chronological order of bases is established. The bases that are read do not need to be contiguous, although this is preferred, nor does every base on the entire fragment have to be sequenced during the sequencing. Sequencing can be carried out using any suitable sequencing technique, wherein nucleotides or oligonucleotides are added successively to a free 3' hydroxyl group, resulting in synthesis of a polynucleotide chain in the 5' to 3' direction. The nature of the nucleotide added is preferably determined after each nucleotide addition. Sequencing techniques using sequencing by ligation, wherein not every contiguous base is sequenced, and techniques such as massively parallel signature sequencing (MPSS) where bases are removed from, rather than added to, the strands on the surface are also amenable to use with the systems and devices of the invention.
  • In certain embodiments, the current invention utilizes sequencing-by-synthesis (SBS). In SBS, four fluorescently labeled modified nucleotides are used to sequence dense clusters of amplified DNA (possibly millions of clusters) present on the surface of a substrate (e.g., a flowcell). The inventors and coworkers have described various additional aspects regarding SBS procedures and methods which can be utilized with the systems and devices herein. See, e.g., WO04018497 , WO04018493 and US7057026 (nucleotides), WO05024010 and WO06120433 (polymerases), WO05065814 (surface attachment techniques), and WO 9844151 , WO06064199 and WO07010251 , the contents of each of which are incorporated herein by reference in their entirety.
  • In particular uses of the systems/devices herein the flowcells containing the nucleic acid samples for sequencing are placed within the appropriate flowcell holder of the present invention (various embodiments of which are described herein). The samples for sequencing can take the form of single molecules, amplified single molecules in the form of clusters, or beads comprising molecules of nucleic acid. The nucleic acids are prepared such that they comprise an oligonucleotide primer adjacent to an unknown target sequence. To initiate the first SBS sequencing cycle, one or more differently labeled nucleotides, and DNA polymerase, etc., are flowed into/through the flowcell by the fluid flow subsystem (various embodiments of which are described herein). Either a single nucleotide can be added at a time, or the nucleotides used in the sequencing procedure can be specially designed to possess a reversible termination property, thus allowing each cycle of the sequencing reaction to occur simultaneously in the presence of all four labeled nucleotides (A, C, T, G). Where the four nucleotides are mixed together, the polymerase is able to select the correct base to incorporate and each sequence is extended by a single base. In such methods of using the systems of the invention, the natural competition between all four alternatives leads to higher accuracy than wherein only one nucleotide is present in the reaction mixture (where most of the sequences are therefore not exposed to the correct nucleotide). Sequences where a particular base is repeated one after another (e.g., homopolymers) are addressed like any other sequence and with high accuracy.
  • The fluid flow subsystem also flows the appropriate reagents to remove the blocked 3' terminus (if appropriate) and the fluorophore from each incorporated base. The substrate can be exposed either to a second round of the four blocked nucleotides, or optionally to a second round with a different individual nucleotide. Such cycles are then repeated and the sequence of each cluster is read over the multiple chemistry cycles. The computer aspect of the current invention can optionally align the sequence data gathered from each single molecule, cluster or bead to determine the sequence of longer polymers, etc. Alternatively, the image processing and alignment can be performed on a separate computer.
  • The heating/cooling components of the system regulate the reaction conditions within the flowcell channels and reagent storage areas/containers (and optionally the camera, optics, and/or other components), while the fluid flow components allow the substrate surface to be exposed to suitable reagents for incorporation (e.g., the appropriate fluorescently labeled nucleotides to be incorporated) while unincorporated reagents are rinsed away. An optional movable stage upon which the flowcell is placed allows the flowcell to be brought into proper orientation for laser (or other light) excitation of the substrate and optionally moved in relation to a lens objective to allow reading of different areas of the substrate. Additionally, other components of the system are also optionally movable/adjustable (e.g., the camera, the lens objective, the heater/cooler, etc.). During laser excitation, the image/location of emitted fluorescence from the nucleic acids on the substrate is captured by the camera component, thereby, recording the identity, in the computer component, of the first base for each single molecule, cluster or bead.
  • Figure 2 displays a photograph of an exemplary arrangement of a system of the invention. As can be seen, the system can be divided into several basic groupings, e.g., area 200 comprising fluidics and reagent storage (including pumps and motors or the like for producing and regulating fluid flow, heaters/coolers for proper reagent temperatures, etc.), area 210 comprising flowcell and detection (including one or more cameras or similar devices, one or more lasers or other light sources, one or more appropriate optical filters and lenses, a temperature control actuator, e.g., with Peltier heating/cooling for control of the temperature conditions of the flowcell, a movable staging platform and motors controlling such to correctly position the various devices/components within the system), and area 220 comprising a computer module (including memory and a user interface such as a display panel and keyboard, etc.).
  • Figure 3 shows a photograph of a flowcell (flowcell 300) placed within an exemplary system. A laser coupled through optical fiber 320 is positioned to illuminate the flowcell (which contains the nucleic acid samples to be sequenced) while an objective lens component (component 310) captures and monitors the various fluorescent emissions once the fluorophores are illuminated by a laser or other light. Also as can be seen in Figure 3, reagents are flowed through the flowcell through one or more tubes (tube 330) which connect to the appropriate reagent storage, etc. The flowcell in Figure 3 is placed within flowcell holder 340 (which is, in turn, placed upon movable staging area 350). The flowcell holder keeps the flowcell secure in the proper position in relation to the laser, the prism (which directs laser illumination onto the imaging surface), and the camera system, while the sequencing occurs. Other flowcells and flowcell configurations are set forth below.
  • The various embodiments of the current invention present several novel features (again, it will be appreciated that not all features are necessarily present in all embodiments unless specifically stated to be so). For example, the systems herein can use two excitation lasers coupled through a fiberoptic device to ensure that they illuminate the same area (i.e. that the illuminated areas, or footprints, of the lasers overlap). Additionally, the current invention can contain a shaking, squeezed, or waveplate modulated fiber (mode scrambler) such that the optical intensity from a multimode beam is made uniform over the whole illumination footprint. The shape of the fiber may be adjusted, for example to be square or rectangular, such that the shape of the illumination can be matched to the shape of the data collection device (e.g., a CCD with square pixels). Also, in certain embodiments, a single laser excites two fluorophores, one with a narrow emission filter near the wavelength, and one with a wider band emission filter at longer wavelength. Such arrangement normalizes the relative intensities of the two dyes (with the same bandwidth filters, the dye further from the laser wavelength would be much weaker). The embodiments herein also can comprise a moving stage such that the chemistry (which requires heating and cooling) can happen on the same instrument, but out of the optical train. The systems herein also often contain an autofocus system to allow automated imaging of many tiles, and contain a fluidics system for performing online fluidic changes. The individual components of the system/device (e.g., light source, camera, etc.) can optionally each have its own power source or supply or can optionally all be powered via one source. As will be appreciated, while the components herein are often described in isolation or in relation to only one or two other components, that the various components in the embodiments are typically operably and/or functionally connected and work together in the systems/devices herein.
  • Flowcells
  • In various embodiments, the systems herein comprise one or more substrates upon which the nucleic acids to be sequenced are bound, attached or associated. See, e.g., WO 9844151 or WO0246456 . In certain embodiments, the substrate is within a channel or other area as part of a "flowcell." The flowcells used in the various embodiments of the invention can comprise millions of individual nucleic acid clusters, e.g., about 2-8 million clusters per channel. Each of such clusters can give read lengths of at least 25 bases for DNA sequencing and 20 bases for gene expression analysis. The systems herein can generate a gigabase (one billion bases) of sequence per run (e.g., 5 million nucleic acid clusters per channel, 8 channels per flowcell, 25 bases per polynucleotide).
  • Figures 4A and 4B display one exemplary embodiment of a flowcell. As can be seen, the particular flowcell embodiment, flowcell 400, comprises base layer 410 (e.g., of borosilicate glass 1000 µm in depth), channel layer 420 (e.g., of etched silicon 100 µm in depth) overlaid upon the base layer, and cover, or top, layer 430 (e.g., 300 µm in depth). When the layers are assembled together, enclosed channels are formed having inlet/outlets at either end through the cover. As will be apparent from the description of additional embodiments below, some flowcells can comprise openings for the channels on the bottom of the flowcell.
  • The channeled layer can optionally be constructed using standard photolithographic methods, with which those of skill in the art will be familiar. One such method which can be used in the current invention, involves exposing a 100 µm layer of silicon and etching away the exposed channel using Deep Reactive Ion Etching or wet etching.
  • It will be appreciated that while particular flowcell configurations are present herein, such configurations should not necessarily be taken as limiting. Thus, for example, various flowcells herein can comprise different numbers of channels (e.g., 1 channel, 2 or more channels, 4 or more channels, or 6, 8, 10, 16 or more channels, etc. Additionally, various flowcells can comprise channels of different depths and/or widths (different both between channels in different flowcells and different between channels within the same flowcell). For example, while the channels formed in the cell in Figure 4B are 100 µm deep, other embodiments can optionally comprise channels of greater depth (e.g., 500 µm) or lesser depth (e.g., 50 µm). Additional exemplary flowcell designs are shown in Figures 4C and 4D (e.g., a flowcell with "wide" channels, such as channels 440 in Figure 4C, having two channels with 8 inlet and outlet ports (ports 445 - 8 inlet and 8 outlet) to maintain flow uniformity and a center wall, such as wall 450, for added structural support; or a flowcell with offset channels, such as the 16 offset channels (channels 480), etc.). The flowcells can be designed to maximize the collection of fluorescence from the illuminated surface and obtain diffraction limited imaging. For example, in the design shown in figure 4C, in particular embodiments, the light comes into the channel through 1000 µm thick bottom layer 460, which can be made of borosilicate glass, fused silica or other material as described herein, and the emitted light travels through 100 µm depth of aqueous solution within the channel and 300 µm depth of "top" layer material 470. However, in some embodiments, the thickness of the "top" layer may be less than 300 µm to prevent spherical aberrations and to image a diffraction limited spot. For example the thickness of the top layer can be around 170 µm for use with a standard diffraction limited optical system. To use the thicker top layer without suffering from spherical aberrations, the objective can optionally be custom designed, e.g., as described herein.
  • In the various embodiments herein, the flowcells can be created from/with a number of possible materials. For example, in some embodiments, the flowcells can comprise photosensitive glass(es) such as Foturan® (Mikroglas, Mainz, Germany) or Fotoform® (Hoya, Tokyo, Japan) that can be formed and manipulated as necessary. Other possible materials can include plastics such as cyclic olefin copolymers (e.g., Topas® (Ticona, Florence, KY) or Zeonor® (Zeon Chemicals, Louisville, KY)) which have excellent optical properties and can withstand elevated temperatures if need be (e.g., up to 100°C). As will be apparent from Figure 4, the flowcells can comprise a number of different materials within the same cell. Thus, in some embodiments, the base layer, the walls of the channels, and the top/cover layer can optionally be of different materials.
  • While the example in Figure 4B shows a flowcell comprised of 3 layers, other embodiments can comprise 2 layers, e.g., a base layer having channels etched/ablated/formed within it and a top cover layer, etc. Additionally, other embodiments can comprise flowcells having only one layer which comprises the flow channel etched/ablated/otherwise formed within it.
  • In some embodiments, the flowcells comprise Foturan®. Foturan is a photosensitive glass which can be structured for a variety of purposes. It combines various desired glass properties (e.g., transparency, hardness, chemical and thermal resistance, etc.) and the ability to achieve very fine structures with tight tolerances and high aspect ratios (hole depth/hole width). With Foturan® the smallest structures possible are usually, e.g., 25 µm with a roughness of 1 µm.
  • Figure 5A, gives a schematic diagram of one possible way of patterning a flowcell (e.g., one comprising Foturan®). First the desired pattern is masked out with masks 500, onto the surface of substrate 510 which is then exposed to UV light. In such exposure step, the glass is exposed to UV light at a wavelength between 290 and 330 nm. It can be possible to illuminate material thicknesses of up to 2 mm. An energy density of approximately 20 J/cm2 is typically sufficient to structurize a 1 mm thick Foturan® plate. During the UV exposure step, silver or other doped atoms are coalesced in the illuminated areas (areas 520). Next, during a heat treatment between 500°C and 600°C, the glass crystallizes around the silver atoms in area 520. Finally, the crystalline regions, when etched with a 10% hydrofluoric acid solution at room temperature (anisotropic etching), have an etching rate up to 20 times higher than that of the vitreous regions, thus resulting in channels 530. If wet chemical etching is supported by ultrasonic etching or by sprayetching, the resulting structures display a large aspect ratio. Figure 5B shows a transmission spectra from a sample of Foturan glass (d = 1mm).
  • Figure 6, panels A through E show an exemplary etching process to construct a sample flowcell as used herein. In Figure 6A, channels 600 (seen in an end view) and through-holes 605 (seen in an end view) are exposed/etched into layer 630. Layer 630 is the "top" layer of a two layer flowcell as can be seen in Figure 6E (mated with bottom layer 620). The through-holes (where reagents/fluids enter into the flowcell channels) and channels can be etched into layer 630 through a 3-D process such as those available from Invenios (Santa Barbara, CA). Top layer 630 can comprise Foturan which, as described, can be UV etched. Foturan, when exposed to UV, changes color and becomes optically opaque (or pseudo- opaque). Thus in Figure 6B, layer 630 has been masked and light exposed to produce darkened areas 610 within the layer (similar to the masking in Figure 5A, but without the further etching). Such optically opaque areas can be helpful in blocking misdirected light, light scatter, or other nondesirable reflections that could otherwise negatively affect the quality of sequence reading herein. In other embodiments, a thin (e.g., 100-500 nm) layer of metal such as chrome or nickel is optionally deposited between the layers of the flowcell (e.g., between the top and bottom layers in Figure 6E) to help block unwanted light scattering. Figures 6C and 6D display the mating of bottom layer 620 with channel layer 630 and Figure 6E shows a cut away view of the same.
  • In various embodiments, the layers of the flowcells are attached to one another in any of a number of different ways. For example, the layers can be attached via adhesives, bonding (e.g., heat, chemical, etc.), and/or mechanical methods. Those of skill in the art will be familiar with numerous methods and techniques to attach various glass/plastic/silicon layers to one another.
  • Again, while particular flowcell designs and constructions are described herein, such descriptions should not necessarily be taken as limiting; other flowcells of the invention can comprise different materials and designs than those presented herein and/or can be created through different etching/ablation techniques or other creation methods than those disclosed herein. Thus, particular flowcell compositions or construction methods should not necessarily be taken as limiting on all embodiments.
  • Fluid Flow
  • In the various embodiments herein, the reagents, buffers, etc. used in the sequencing of the nucleic acids are regulated and dispensed via a fluid flow subsystem or aspect. Figures 7A-C present generalized diagrams of exemplary fluid flow arrangements of the invention, set up in one way push, eight way pull, and one way pull configurations respectively. In general, the fluid flow subsystem transports the appropriate reagents (e.g., enzymes, buffers, dyes, nucleotides, etc.) at the appropriate rate and optionally at the appropriate temperature, from reagent storage areas (e.g., bottles, or other storage containers) through the flowcell and optionally to a waste receiving area.
  • The fluid flow aspect is optionally computer controlled and can optionally control the temperature of the various reagent components. For example, certain components are optionally held at cooled temperatures such as 4°C +/- 1°C (e.g., for enzyme containing solutions), while other reagents are optionally held at elevated temperatures (e.g., buffers to be flowed through the flowcell when a particular enzymatic reaction is occurring at the elevated temperature).
  • In some embodiments, various solutions are optionally mixed prior to flow through the flowcell (e.g., a concentrated buffer mixed with a diluent, appropriate nucleotides, etc.). Such mixing and regulation is also optionally controlled by the fluid flow aspect of the invention. It is advantageous if the distance between the mixed fluids and the flowcell is minimized in many embodiments. Therefore the pump can be placed after the flowcell and used to pull the reagents into the flowcell (Figure 7B and 7C) as opposed to having the pump push the reagents into the flowcell (as in Figure 7A). Such pull configurations mean that any materials trapped in dead volumes within the pump do not contaminate the flowcell. The pump can be a syringe type pump, and can be configured to have one syringe per flow channel to ensure even flow through each channel of the flowcell. The pump can be an 8 way pump, if it is desired to use an 8 way flowcell, such as for example a Kloehn 8 way syringe pump (Kloehn, Las Vegas, NV). A fluidics diagram of an 8 way pull configuration is shown in figure 7B. In Figure 7A, fluidic reagents are stored in reagent containers 700 (e.g., buffers at room temperature, 5X SSC buffer, enzymology buffer, water, cleavage buffer, etc.) and 710 (e.g., cooled containers for enzymes, enzyme mixes, water, scanning mix, etc.). Pump 730 moves the fluids from the reagent containers through reagent valve 740, priming/waste valve 770 and into/through flowcell 760.
  • In figure 7B, fluidic reagents are stored in reagent containers 702 (e.g., buffers at room temperature similar to those listed above) and 703 (e.g., cooled containers for enzymes, etc. similar to those listed above), linked through reagent valve 701. Those of skill in the art will be familiar with multi-way valves (such as the reagent valves) used to allow controllable access of/to multiple lines/containers. The reagent valve is linked into flowcell 705 via an optional priming valve (or waste valve) 704, connected to optional priming pump 706. The priming pump can optionally draw reagents from the containers up through the tubing so that the reagents are "ready to go" into the flowcell. Thus, dead air, reagents at the wrong temperature (e.g., because of sitting in tubing), etc. will be avoided. When the priming pump is drawing, the outflow is shunted into the waste area. During non-priming use, the reagents can be pulled through the flowcell using 8 channel pump 707, which is connect to waste reservoir 708.
  • In either embodiment (push or pull), the fluidic configurations can comprise "sipper" tubes or the like that extend into the various reagent containers in order to extract the reagents from the containers. Figure 7C shows a single channel pump rather than an 8 channel pump. Single channel pump 726 can also act as the optional priming pump, and thus optional priming pump or waste valve 723 can be connected directly to pump 726 through bypass 725. The arrangement of components is similar in this embodiment as to that of Figure 7B. Thus it comprises reagent containers 721 and 722, multi-way selector valve 720, flowcell 724, etc.
  • The fluid flow itself is optionally driven by any of a number of pump types, (e.g., positive/negative displacement, vacuum, peristaltic, etc.) such as an Encynova® 2-1 Pump (Encynova, Greeley, CO) or a Kloehn® V3 Syringe Pump (Kloehn, Las Vegas, NV). Again, it will be appreciated that specific recitation of particular pumps, etc. herein should not be taken as necessarily limiting and that various embodiments can comprise different pumps and/or pump types than those listed herein. In certain embodiments, the fluid delivery rate is from about 50 µL to about 500 µL/min (e.g., controlled +/- 2 µL) for the 8 channels. In the 8 way pull configuration, the flow can be between 10-100 µl/min/channel, depending on the process. In some embodiments, the maximum volume of nucleotide reagents required for sequencing a polynucleotide of 25 bases is about 12 mL.
  • Which ever pump/pump type is used herein, the reagents are optionally transported from their storage areas to the flowcell through tubing. Such tubing, such as PTFE, can be chosen in order to, e.g., minimize interaction with the reagents. The diameter of the tubing can vary between embodiments (and/or optionally between different reagent storage areas), but can be chosen based on, e.g., the desire to decrease "dead volume" or the amount of fluid left in the lines. Furthermore, the size of the tubing can optionally vary from one area of a flow path to another. For example, the tube size from a reagent storage area can be of a different diameter than the size of the tube from the pump to the flowcell, etc.
  • The fluid flow subsystem of the invention also can control the flow rate of the reagents involved. The flow rate is optionally adjustable for each flow path (e.g., some flow paths can proceed at higher flow rates than others; flow rates can optionally be reversed; different channels can receive different reagent flows or different timings of reagent flows, etc.). The flow rate can be set in conjunction with the tube diameter for each flow path in order to have the proper volume of reagent, etc in the flowcell at a given time. For example, in some embodiments, the tubing through which the reagents flow is 0.3 mm ID, 0.5 mm, or 1.0 mm while the flow rate is 480 µL/min or 120 µL/min. In some embodiments, the speed of flow is optionally balanced to optimize the reactions of interest. High flow can cause efficient clearing of the lines and minimize the time spent in changing the reagents in a given flowcell volume, but can also cause a higher level of shear flow at the substrate surface and can cause a greater problem with leaks or bubbles. A typical flow rate for the introduction of reagents can be 15 µl/min/channel in some embodiments.
  • The system can be further equipped with pressure sensors that automatically detect and report features of the fluidic performance of the system, such as leaks, blockages and flow volumes. Such pressure or flow sensors can be useful in instrument maintenance and troubleshooting. The fluidic system can be controlled by the one or more computer component, e.g., as described below. It will be appreciated that the fluid flow configurations in the various embodiments of the invention can vary, e.g., in terms of number of reagent containers, tubing length/diameter/composition, types of selector valves and pumps, etc.
  • Heating/Cooling
  • In some embodiments, the systems herein comprise a heating/cooling control component having heating/cooling capabilities, e.g., through Peltier devices, etc. Optionally, the various components herein (e.g., the flowcell and its contents) can be heated by a resistive heating element and cooled through convection to create reaction conditions above ambient temperature. Such heating/cooling component(s) can control the temperature of the flowcells (and the fluids within them) during the various reactions required in sequencing-by-synthesis. An exemplary flowcell temperature control system is shown in Figure 8 (in isolation from the other components of the system). In Figure 8, Peltier fan 800 is shown in relationship to heat sink 810 and Peltier heater 820. The flowcell heating/cooling component is optionally positionable and/or movable in relation to the other components of the system (e.g., the flowcell and flowcell holder, etc.). Thus, the heating/cooling component can be moved into place when needed (e.g., to raise the temperature of the reagents in the flowcell to allow for enzyme activity, etc.) and moved away when not needed. Additionally and/or alternatively, the flowcell and flowcell holder can optionally be moved in relation to the heating/cooling component. See Figure 10A and 10B below. In various embodiments, the temperature control elements control the flowcell temperature, e.g., from about 20°C to about 60°C or any other temperature/temperature ranges as required by the reactions to be done within the systems/devices. The temperature of the heating element can be adjusted to control the temperature of the flowcell and the reagents therein. As the flowcell is exposed to a flow of cooled reagents, the temperature of the heating element may be higher than the temperature desired at the surface of the flowcell. For example the heating element may be set to 55 °C to obtain a flowcell temperature of 45 °C.
  • Those of skill in the art will be familiar with Peltier devices used for temperature control (which can optionally be used in the systems herein). Again, it will be appreciated that while certain heating/cooling devices are recited herein, such should not be construed as necessarily limiting. Thus, in certain embodiments heating/cooling devices other than Peltier devices are optionally comprised within the present invention. In typical embodiments, notwithstanding the type of device, the heating/cooling component is optionally controlled (e.g., in terms of temperature, time at particular temperatures, movement of the component, and/or movement of other devices such as the flowcell holder to the heating/cooling component) by the computer component (see below).
  • In some embodiments, additional heating/cooling elements can optionally regulate the temperature of other components in addition to or alternate to the flowcell. For example, heating/cooling components can optionally regulate the temperature of the camera, the reagent reservoirs, which can be cooled, for example to 4°C to prolong the storage life of the reagents during long sequencing runs, the temperature of the atmosphere inside the instrument etc.
  • Multiple Flowcells and alternative TIRF and Heating/Cooling Approaches
  • In certain embodiments herein, the systems/devices can comprise additional approaches to flowcell configuration, TIR illumination, heating/cooling configurations of the flowcell(s), and in how the flowcells are held/stabilized within the device. While such approaches can optionally be utilized together in certain embodiments, it will be appreciated that they each can be used in any combination, e.g., with each other, with any of the other approaches described herein, etc.
  • In some embodiments, the flowcells herein can be "bottom flow" flowcells. Thus, as opposed to the flowcells, e.g., as shown in Figures 4, 6, and 9 where the flowcells are clamped down and fluid flow enters from the top side of the flowcell, some flowcells can comprise configurations that allow fluid flow that enters from the bottom of the flowcell. Such bottom flowcells can be similar in construction and composition as "top flow" flowcells. In some embodiments bottom flow flowcells can comprise less fluidic dead volume (and use more of the whole channel length than top flow flowcells, e.g., since the ends of the flowcells are not covered by clamps/manifolds, etc.). See, e.g., Figure 44- 49.
  • Bottom flow flowcells can optionally be held to the flowcell holder through vacuum chucking rather than clamps. Thus, a vacuum can hold the flowcell into the correct position within the device so that proper illumination and imaging can take place. Cf., Figures 44-49 with Figure 9. Thus, some embodiments herein also comprise one or more vacuum creation device to create a vacuum (or partial vacuum, etc.) to hold the flowcell and/or prism to the flowcell holder, XY stage, etc.
  • Various examples of flowcell holder manifolds are shown in Figure 46 that can be used with bottom flow flowcells. As can be seen, the fluids flowed into/through/out of the flowcell are directed through various branching tubes within the manifolds to/ from specific channels within the flowcell. Again, such embodiments can optionally not obstruct any (or not substantially any) of the top surface of the flowcell which might interfere with illumination/imaging of the full length of the channels. Figure 47 displays an exemplary fluidic valve. Such valve has no moving parts or vibrations and a low dead volume. In such arrangements, each reagent bottle/container can have an open/close valve. After drawing a fluid, air can be injected before closing the reservoir valve thereby forcing an air gap valve between reagents. Cooled reagents can be returned to their reservoirs and all reagents in case of a system shut down. Also, an air injection pump can be added to the push/pull pump (e.g., a kloehn pump).
  • Another approach to illumination can comprise "top down" illumination. Such top down approach can be useful when used in conjunction with vacuum chucking (and bottom temperature control below). It can optionally be problematic to illuminate from the bottom (e.g., as in Figure 1, etc.) in configurations with vacuum chucking and bottom temperature control since such embodiments often utilize the space below the flowcell. As can be seen in Figure 44, top down or side illumination comes from above into prism 4401 upon which flowcell 4402 rests (and is optionally held down by vacuum). Such arrangement can also help prevent bowing of the flowcell which presentation can aid in autofocusing and flat field imaging and can aid in configuration with multiple flowcells having simultaneous reading, etc. Laser illumination 4400 is also shown entering into the prism in Figure 44 as is mirror 4405 and manifold/fluidic connector 4404.
  • Figure 45 shows another approach to thermodynamic control of a flowcell (and the reagents and reactions within it). Figure 45 shows an exemplary embodiment of a bottom temperature controlled device. In some such embodiments, the aspect can comprise a water cooled bench that can help assure dimensional stability during read cycles and controlled scan buffer temperature. A thermal plate can extend past the prism and flowcell and under the manifolds to optionally help in uniform temperature control. Fluids can optionally be preheated when passing through the inlet manifold. Also, RTD temperature feedback can be imbedded in top of the prism to assure that the flowcell is at the desired set temperature and that thermal resistant effects of the prism are minimized.
  • Configurations having multiple flowcells within a flowcell holder are shown in Figure 48. As can be seen, up to four flowcells can be loaded into the holder in Figure 48A (or two double wide flowcells, e.g., having 18-20 channels each). Peltiers or other similar devices can be beneath the flowcells and can optionally be water cooled through the holder bench aspect (which can be kept at room temperature optionally).
  • Stage and Flowcell Holder
  • Placement and movement of the flowcell (and thus the nucleic acids to be sequenced) is controlled and secured by, e.g., a movable stage upon which the flowcell and flowcell holder (or other substrate) are located. Such movable stage can optionally allow movement of the flowcell in relation to the laser illumination and lens objective to read the sequencing reactions within the channels. If desired, the scanning stage or other components can be actively cooled during the scanning cycle to control the temperature of the substrate during the imaging cycles.
  • Figure 9, panels A through D, displays schematic diagrams of an exemplary flowcell holder of the current system. Figure 9A shows flowcell holder 900 before a flowcell is placed upon it. As can be seen, the holder comprises adjustable clamps 910 (optionally spring loaded) to securely fasten the flowcell to the holder and optionally one or more manifolds (e.g., optionally comprised within the clamps) to fluidically connect the flowcell channels to the rest of the fluidic system. A manifold can individually connect each of the channels in parallel. Alternatively, a manifold can connect the channels such that they are connected via a single inlet line that is split to flow in parallel to each channel, or can be configured as a "serpentine" configuration to make a single fluid flow. Such a manifold can be configured to contain a single 1-8 split, or can comprise a binary splitter wherein each fluid channel is only split into 2, to obtain a split from 1-2-4-8, in order to give a more uniform flow along each of the 8 channels. In the 8 way pull configuration, the "exit" manifold from the flowcell can comprise 8 individual ports, each connected to a barrel of an 8 way syringe pump, whilst the "inlet" manifold can contain a single entry tube to reduce the length of tubing needed to fill the flowcell. The inlet manifold can contain a 1-8 splitter or a binary 1-2-4-8 splitter for partitioning the flow evenly down each of the 8 channels. Figure 9B also shows the presence of adjustable prism 920 that optionally can be raised/lowered to come into contact with the underside of the flowcell. The prism is used in conjunction with the lasers in the TIRF activity. In particular embodiments, oil (e.g., immersion oil such as that available from Cargille, catalog #19570 or the like) is placed between the prism and the flowcell in a uniform and continuous layer to create total internal reflection through the layer of air between the prism and the flowcell glass. Figure 9C shows placement of flowcell 930 upon the holder and prism and Figure 9D shows the flowcell clamped to the flowcell holder with handle/clamp 940 being lowered to help secure the clamps and flowcell.
  • The flowcell and flowcell holder can be situated upon a movable stage or platform. Such stage optionally is adjustable along, X, Y, and Z axes. This allows fine scale height and placement adjustment of the flowcell in relation to the lasers, camera, lens optics, etc, and allows the surface of the flowcell to be kept in focus relative to the imaging device. Furthermore, the movable stage can optionally allow the flowcell to be moved back and forth between the heating/cooling component and the optic/laser components (i.e., to allow enzymatic reactions when heated and to quantify the outcome of such reactions with the camera/laser components). Figure 10 shows photographs depicting movement of flowcell 1020 and flowcell holder 1010 between the heating/cooling element (left picture) and the camera/laser elements (right picture). Thus the x and y components can allow the flowcell to be moved laterally (e.g., by 10s of centimeters), whilst the height can be adjusted (e.g., by 10s of nanometers) vertically to allow focusing of the images. Alternatively, the stage also can be simply an XY stage with no vertical setting, and the lens objective can be adjustable in the Z plane to ensure focus is maintained. It will be appreciated that the heating/cooling elements are optionally movable as well, e.g., in order to come into closer proximity with the flowcell, etc. Cf., Figure 10 left picture (heating/cooling device raised) and Figure 10 right picture (heating/cooling device lowered onto flowcell).
  • Figure 10A shows a photograph of the instrument before and during the heating step. Peltier device 1000 (comprised of fan 1001, heat sink 1002 and heater unit 1003) moves in the vertical direction to come into contact with the flowcell 1020 and flowcell holder 1010 mounted on XY stage 1050. Reagents are introduced into the flowcell via tube 1040. The flowcell can move to a position located under camera 1030 for imaging. A schematic representation of the device in the imaging location is shown in figure 10B, where the Peltier device 1070 is in the raised position (with fan 1071, heatsink 1072, and heater 1073), flowcell 1085 and stage 1086 are sited next to the fiber optic mount 1090 and below lens objective 1080. The fiber optic mount is connected to the Z stage 1075, which also controls the height of lens objective 1080. The flowcell is clamped in place onto the flowcell holder by the manifold lever/handle 1095.
  • Additionally, it will be appreciated that the various components herein, e.g., the laser components, heating/cooling components, etc., are typically arranged on a scaffolding, chassis, or framework and optionally enclosed within a housing to fully or partially enclose the instrument. The particular configuration of such framework and/or housing can optionally vary in different embodiments based upon, e.g., the particular components, their size, etc. In typical embodiments however, the framework keeps the various components secure and in the proper location and orientation while also optionally aiding in the movement of the components when necessary. The framework should be rigid enough to prevent vibrations within the instrument and the various components. For example the mode scrambler can be motion damped and vibrationally isolated from the stage to prevent shaking of the flowcell during imaging. Figure 11A shows a schematic displaying an exemplary framework holding the camera (1100), heating/cooling components 1110, (cf., Figure 8) flowcell and flowcell holder, and movable stage 1120. Additional aspects of framework and mounting that aid in tying together the various components and aspects of the device/system include various alignment and mounting pins/locations can be seen in Figure 11B which shows the bearing slide for laser piece vertical adjustment 1165 and flowcell leveling adjustment component 1175. Other frameworks and housing, including external covers (skins) for the housing can be seen in Figure 12 along with computer monitor 1201.
  • Excitation and Observation
  • In certain embodiments herein, the incorporation of specific nucleic acid bases with their accompanying specific fluorescences is tracked via laser excitation and camera observation. In various embodiments, the illumination is performed using Total Internal Reflection (TIR) comprising a laser component. It will be appreciated that a "TIRF laser," "TIRF laser system," "TIR laser," and other similar terminology herein refers to a TIRF (Total Internal Reflection Fluorescence) based detection instrument/system using excitation, e.g., lasers or other types of non-laser excitation from such light sources as LED, halogen, and xenon arc lamps (all of which are also included in the current description of TIRF, TIRF laser, TIRF laser system, etc. herein). Thus, a "TIRF laser" is a laser used with a TIRF system, while a "TIRF laser system" is a TIRF system using a laser, etc. Again, however, the TIRF systems herein (even when described in terms of having laser usage, etc.) should also be understood to include those TIRF systems/instruments comprising non-laser based excitation sources. Those of skill in the art will be well aware of different aspects of TIRF systems and their general use. In various embodiments, the camera component comprises a CCD camera. In some embodiments, the laser comprises dual individually modulated 50 mW to 500 mW solid state and/or semiconductor lasers coupled to a TIRF· prism, optionally with excitation wavelengths of 532 nm and 660 nm. The coupling of the laser into the instrument can be via an optical fiber to help ensure that the footprints of the two lasers are focused on the same area of the substrate (i.e., overlap).
  • Mode Scrambling
  • In the various embodiments herein, the area wherein the laser(s) or other excitation source(s) illuminate the sample (the area of which illumination is referred to as the "footprint") is typically desired to be spatially flat and uniform. In many embodiments the devices/systems herein take advantage of properties of multimode fibers that allow propagation of all optical modes through their cores with near equal amplitude to produce a flat or top-hat profile illumination footprint from the laser on the illuminated substrate surface (e.g., the surface of a flowcell), etc. However, the finite number of modes present in such fibers can constructively and destructively interfere with each other and produce local minima and maxima in the intensity profile of the laser (or other light). See, e.g., Figure 33A and 34A which show minima/maxima resulting from uncorrected output from multimode fibers. To ameliorate this problem, some embodiments herein produce a substantially uniform footprint by use of dynamic mode scrambling by constantly changing the index of refraction within the illumination beam, e.g., by modulating the beam with a waveplate, or by shaking, squeezing or compressing one or more areas of a fiber carrying the illumination beam. Thus, some embodiments of the current invention produce a substantially uniform flat-top output (i.e., a substantially uniform illumination/excitation footprint from a laser or light source) by dynamically scrambling the modes in an illuminating beam, e.g., by squeezing/compressing a fiber carrying the beam in one or more area over its length. Figures 33 and 34 summarize various embodiments of mode scrambling as described herein. See below.
  • Dynamic Mode Scrambling and Low Loss beam shaping
  • In certain embodiments, the devices herein comprise component(s) to produce a "top-hat" illumination, e.g., a uniform or substantially uniform illumination over a particular illumination footprint, as seen in Figure 35. Such embodiments comprise one or more aspects that dynamically change the index of refraction within the medium transmitting the illumination (e.g., a fiber) at one or more nodes. For example, a fiber can be squeezed at various locations along its length to induce a continuously changing index of refraction. Such squeezing of the fiber, e.g., a Step Index Fiber, can be used to spatially/temporally scramble the modes in the fiber to cause sufficient overlap over a desired integration time of the output illumination. As explained also herein (see below) the fiber can also be shaken, rotated, vibrated or physically deformed in other ways to change the optical path through the fiber.
  • In general, the dynamic scrambling of the modes in the fibers allows achievement of spatially uniform illumination over a minimum user defined integration time. This thus prevents interference of propagating modes of monochromatic light in multimode fibers which would produce light and dark patterns in the resulting beam. It is optionally sufficient that these modes disappear over the minimum integration time. Thus, in some embodiments, the relative path lengths of these modes within the illumination beam are rapidly varied by introducing time variable curvature and index variations into the fiber, e.g., by mechanical means.
  • It will be appreciated that several parameters of the dynamic mode scrambling can optionally be varied or can comprise a range of different configurations. However, in general, dynamic mode scrambling comprises one or more aspects/components used to dynamically change the index of refraction of an illumination beam in order to average out an end illumination footprint. While many existing refractive optical concepts require an input Gaussian beam and existing diffractive optical concepts are often wavelength dependent, the present embodiment does not require a Gaussian beam input and is wavelength independent.
  • In their various embodiments, the devices/systems herein desire a uniformly illuminated field for excitation/measurement of the sequencing reactions, etc. Thus, the uneven light/dark patterns that result from interference of propagating modes of monochromatic light in a multimode fiber is typically undesirable. Averaging of the light output over an illumination footprint (over a period of observation time such as the time captured by a camera during an imaging) to allow integration of the light means that the light/dark patterns "disappear" or are averaged out, and thus the excitation intensity seen by each fluorophore on the surface should be uniform.
  • Underlying dynamic mode scrambling, is the constant varying of the index of refraction at a point or node of the light beam over time (e.g., by physically squeezing a fiber over time) which causes the light to be scrambled and take different paths and thus averages out the light output in the illumination footprint. Thus, the position of interference minima and maxima changes as the index of refraction of the input beam is changed. If the index of refraction is changed at a frequency that is faster than the image acquisition time, then a spatially uniform image can be produced in the timescale of the observation.
  • It will be appreciated that the current embodiment should not be confused with the common usage of "mode scramble" which most often refers to randomization of an input mode or modes relative to the output. The desired function of the current embodiment is to temporally as well as spatially randomize modes, i.e., producing dynamic scrambling.
  • The dynamic mode scrambling of the current embodiment can also be used in conjunction with fibers comprising cores of particular shapes to achieve a beam shape with uniform illumination. For example, squeezing a fiber with a square core will result in a uniformly illuminated square beam. The beam can be shaped along a particular axis to make a rectangle, or oval shape, which beam is imaged as square or circular when it hits upon the imaging surface. See Figures 17-18. For example, rectangular beams can be generated from optical fibers, as shown in Figure 34.
  • Figure 35 shows the optical output from a variety of different lasers, fibers, and mode scrambling aspects, etc. During device operation, the ends of the fibers were re-imaged onto a beam profiler. Figure 35 shows the effect of dynamic modescrambling (i.e., by manipulation of the fibers at one or more nodes with, e.g., piezo-electric actuators) by comparing the images from different wavelength lasers (e.g., 532 nm and 550 nm) and laser times (solid state and diode) in conjunction with different beam shapers (two versions of rectangles and a circle) by showing the output when the dynamic modescrambling is "on" versus the light output when the modescrambling is "off' for each laser type, etc.
  • It will be appreciated that one embodiment of the device can therefore comprise a dynamic mode scrambler as opposed to static mode scrambler. It is the dynamic variation of index of refraction that causes the modes to overlap over the desired integration time. The index of refraction is constantly changed at one or more location (node). For example, a fiber transmitting the illumination is constantly squeezed at a point with a changing degree of intensity (e.g., from no squeezing to maximum squeezing and back again). The fiber can be temporarily deformed by such squeezing so that its shape changes from a circle to an ellipse to a circle, etc. which, in turn, keeps changing the index of refraction. As soon as the squeezing stops, the mode scrambling stops.
  • Efficiency of averaging of the illumination output in a footprint depends on length of image capture, the degree of change in index of refraction, the type/strength of the light source, etc. Thus, it is a user controllable variable and should not necessarily be taken as limiting. The user can optionally control the degree of scrambling to fine tune the averaging of light output in a footprint.
  • Thus, the time period over which light output averaging is measured is variable, e.g., it can be the period during which an image is captured of the area illuminated by the light output (e.g., tiles (specific image capture areas) upon the flowcells in certain sequencing embodiments herein). In certain embodiments, the time period of scrambling efficiency is equivalent to or substantially equivalent to the expose period for each image captured by a camera (e.g., the CCD camera in particular sequencing embodiments herein). It will be appreciated that such exposure times can vary from embodiment to embodiment, e.g., from less than 1 millisecond to over 1 hour or more depending upon the particular requirements of the embodiment (e.g., at least 1, 5, 10, 25, 50, 100, 250, 500 or more microseconds; at least 1, 5, 10, 25, 50, 100, 250, 500 or more milliseconds; at least 1, 5, 10, 25, 50, 100, 250, 500 or more seconds, etc.). For the sequencing reactions described herein, the imaging time may be of the order of 50-500 milliseconds per exposure.
  • In various embodiments, the current dynamic mode scrambler can, no matter the overall system with which it is used, be used with different light sources/types, different beam media, different ways of changing the index of refraction, different numbers of nodes where the index of refraction is changed, etc.
  • Dynamic mode scrambling is not limited by the particular light/illumination used. Thus, for example, while many embodiments herein optionally use lasers of particular wavelength (e.g., 532 and/or 660 nm), other embodiments can use illumination of entirely different wavelength. The lasers used with dynamic mode scrambling can be, e.g., visible light lasers, IR lasers, narrow alignment lasers, broad linewidth lasers, etc. Again, while particular laser wavelengths are mentioned herein, such recitation should not necessarily be taken as limiting. Of course, it will be appreciated with each different laser type/strength used, that correspondingly, other parameters are optionally adjusted to achieve substantially uniform illumination. For example, the number of nodes where the index of refraction is changed and/or the rate of change of the index at such nodes is optionally different for different light sources to achieve the same degree of uniformity of the footprint.
  • Also, while the examples herein are generally addressed in terms of mode scrambling in fiber optic lines, dynamic mode scrambling is also optionally used with light transmitted through glass, plastic, non-fiber optic lines, air, vacuum, etc. Thus, dynamic mode scrambling is not limited by the medium in which the light is transmitted. Here too, differences in the transmission medium can optionally also match with a difference in other aspects of the mode scrambler needed to achieve substantially uniform output. For example, for light transmitted through air/vacuum (i.e., not contained within a fiber, etc.), the index of refraction is optionally changed/varied by changes in temperature rather than any mechanical change in the transport medium.
  • The index of refraction can optionally be varied through a number of ways. For example, as mentioned above, when the light is not transmitted through a cable/fiber, but rather traverses air/vacuum, the index of refraction of the light beam can be varied by changes in temperature. Thus, one or more heaters/coolers can be used to vary the temperature of one or more node of the light beam to change the index of refraction. For beams that travel through a fiber/cable, the physical properties of the fiber can be changed in order to vary the index of refraction. For example, the fiber can be physically bent, shaken, twisted, squeezed, compressed, pulled, or heated/cooled at one or more nodes to change the index of refraction at those points. The physical interaction with the fiber can be through actual mechanical manipulation (e.g., through rollers, pinchers, etc. and/or through piezo-electric actuators that squeeze the fiber (e.g., similar to those available from General Photonics (Chino, CA)), etc.). Generally, any way of varying the index of refraction can be used.
  • In addition to different ways of changing the index of refraction, the rate of change of the index, the number of nodes, etc. are also optionally variable. Thus, in different embodiments, dynamic mode scrambling can comprise one or more node (i.e., area where the index is varied) on an illumination beam, which node can be fixed/static or movable along the light beam. In a general, but not limiting sense, the greater the number of nodes, the more scrambling occurs. Similarly, for multiple nodes it is typically preferred that the changes in refraction not be synchronized with one another (i.e., it is preferred that the variation in index of refraction be random).
  • Figures 33-35 show examples of mode scrambling with various fiber shapes and various light sources. As can be seen from the images, substantially uniform "top hat" illumination is achieved when the dynamic mode scramble is performed using a vibrating or squeezed fiber. The figures also illustrate that images can be shaped through use of shaped-core fibers. Figure 33 shows a nonscrambled beam output (A) compared with beam outputs wherein the fiber was shaken, e.g., through use of a MKIII MS from Point Source (Hamble, UK) (B), vibrated, e.g., with an MKIV MS from Point Source (C), or squeezed, e.g., through use of one or more piezo-electric squeezer/compressors (e.g., squeezed over 6 nodes at about 500-600 Htz per node) (D). The results shown in Figure 33 were all performed with the same fiber and laser types (e.g., 15 micron step index fiber and a 532 nm solid state laser). Similar results are shown in Figure 34 A-D for a rectangular core fiber: nonscrambled (A), shaken (B), vibrated (C), or squeezed (D). In Figure 34 the examples were all done with the same fiber/laser types. Figure 35 shows similar results on a number of different laser sources and scrambling procedures. Thus in Figure 35 the panels correspond to: 660 um wavelength diode laser in a rectangular core fiber with no mode scrambling (A) and the same fiber with dynamic mode scrambling (B); a 532 um wavelength solid state laser with no mode scrambling (C) and the same fiber with dynamic mode scrambling (D); a 660 um wavelength diode laser (a second rectangular) with no mode scrambling (E) and the same fiber with dynamic mode scrambling (F); a 532 solid state second rectangular fiber with no scrambling (G) and with dynamic mode scrambling (H); a 660 um diode laser (round) with no mode scrambling (I) and with dynamic mode scrambling (J); a 532 um solid state laser with no mode scrambling (K) and with dynamic mode scrambling (L).
  • Low Loss Beam Shapers
  • In some embodiments herein, specific beam shapes such as a square or rectangular laser beams are optionally used. Such shaped illumination allows for efficient exposure and tiling over a surface, e.g., comprising a nucleic acid sample, which can result in higher throughput in various devices herein. This can be advantageous in cases where the imaging is performed using a CCD device with square pixels, as the illumination footprint and imaging area can be tiled to prevent illumination, and photobleaching of areas outside the image capture area.
  • In some embodiments herein, instead of using a mask to shape the beam and re-image the mask onto the sample surface (which can optionally waste energy outside of the mask), the laser is coupled into a square or rectangular (or other shaped) core fiber. Thus, all the available laser power is efficiently used for illumination. Propagation down a sufficient length of such shaped fiber fills the core efficiently to produce the desired illumination shape. The end of this fiber can then be re-imaged onto a sample, e.g., a flowcell substrate. In particular embodiments, such re-imaging of the illumination from the fiber is typically desired to not substantially disturb the top-hat profile and/or beam shape achieved from scrambling and/or beam shaping (or even to distort the beam when it has not been beam shaped or scrambled). Thus, re-imaging aspects (e.g., lens(es), etc.) are appropriately chosen to not distort the achieved profile and optionally to correctly magnify the light output onto the flowcell, etc. Re-imaging, in particular embodiments, can also be chosen to be achromatic (i.e., to be able to function with any wavelength light). In some embodiments, re-imaging components can also be "pistoned" by slightly moving the reimaging components to have the illumination land properly on particular areas of the flowcell.
  • Illumination uniformity in such embodiments can optionally be controlled by the condition of the beam launched into the shaped fiber coupled with the length of the fiber. Illumination uniformity optionally can be enhanced by dynamically scrambling the modes within the shaped fiber. For example utilizing a device that continuously squeezes the shaped core fiber at various locations. See above. The delivered beam dimensions at the sample surface optionally can be manipulated by imaging lenses.
  • Figures 34 and 35 show the results of use of a rectangular core optical fiber. The end of the fiber was re-imaged onto a beam profiler. The image from the beam profile illustrates the desired rectangular beam with uniform illumination in the vertical and horizontal dimensions.
  • The dynamic mode scrambling and/or beam shaping systems comprise components to generate and deliver a substantially uniform and wavelength-switchable evanescent beam to the lower surface of a flowcell channel (or other substrate) in an SBS reader instrument. As is apparent, these components interface with several other modules/components in the overall SBS system (e.g., the various optics components described above, etc.), and can be controlled/directed through one or more computer component.
  • Even though the current dynamic mode scrambling and beam shaping embodiments include, and are described throughout in terms of their interaction with, nucleic acid sequencing systems (e.g., various sequencing by synthesis configurations as described herein), it will be appreciated by those of skill in the art that such embodiments are also applicable to a wide range of other uses/systems. Thus, dynamic mode scrambling can be included in myriad systems comprising one or more aspects to dynamically vary the index of refraction of an illumination beam to mix the optic modes of a multimode optical fiber in order to produce a substantially uniform image or output in a desired timeframe (e.g., such as during the image capture time for a camera or the like). Dynamic mode scrambling can optionally be utilized with systems such as those tracking fluorescence on a plate or microarray or the like, i.e., uses that do not comprise tracking of sequencing reactions.
  • Mode scrambling using Waveplates
  • In various aspects herein, the invention comprises a system for mixing optic modes in a multimode optic fiber through use of waveplates. Such systems comprise a light source (e.g., a laser) which sends light through a multimode optic fiber and also optionally through at least one waveplate and then optionally through a re-imaging lens(es), prism, and onto a substrate (flowcell). The waveplates in such systems can comprise "rotating" waveplates. In some embodiments the waveplates actually physically rotate at various rpms, while in other embodiments, such as with liquid crystal waveplates, the plate "rotates" and alters the polarization of the light passing through it by varying voltage across the liquid crystal. In certain embodiments, the waveplate comprises two or more sections of oriented retarders each of which rotates polarization in different directions. In typical embodiments, the light output from the fiber comprises a substantially uniform light output on a surface over a defined time period. The light output on the surfaces in various embodiments herein comprises reduced intensity minima and reduced intensity maxima in comparison to the output from a multimode optic fiber that does not comprise one or more rotating waveplates.
  • In other aspects, the invention comprises methods for equalizing light output from a multimode optic fiber over a surface in a defined time period by sending light from a light source (e.g., a laser) through a multimode optic fiber and through one or more rotating waveplates. In some embodiments, the output on the surface comprises reduced intensity minima and reduced intensity maxima as compared to the output from a multimode optic fiber that does not comprise one or more rotating waveplate. In some embodiments the waveplates actually physically rotate at various rpms, while in other embodiments, such as with liquid crystal waveplates, the plate "rotates" and alters the polarization of the light passing through it by varying the voltage across the liquid crystal. In certain embodiments, the waveplate comprises two or more sections of oriented retarders each of which rotates polarization in different directions.
  • As used herein in some embodiments, a "waveplate" (or retardation plate or phase shifter or the like) refers to an optical device that alters velocity of light rays as they pass through it, thus, creating a phase difference. Waveplates are typically comprised of a birefringent crystal. Some embodiments can comprise a liquid crystal waveplate.
  • As described above, in particular embodiments comprising laser or other source excitation, the illumination of the sample (the area of which illumination is referred to as the "footprint") is spatially flat and uniform. The optic instruments herein exploit the properties of multimode fibers that allow propagation of all optical modes through their core with near equal amplitude which produces a flat or top-hat profile of the footprint. However the finite number of modes present in such fibers can constructively and destructively interfere with each other, thus producing local minima and maxima in the intensity profile of the laser (or other light). Some embodiments produce a uniform footprint by physically shaking the fiber at a timescale shorter than the exposure time of the camera capturing the images, which averages the intensity minima and maxima and produces a uniform flat top footprint. This shaking can require an off balance DC motor that rotates and shakes the fiber, which in some instances can cause undesired noise and vibrations that need to be damped to avoid causing imaging problems. The shaking can also adversely affect reliability since off balance DC motors have a shorter mean time between failure than balanced motors, and may increase physical wear on the fiber. Because of these factors, mode mixing in a multimode optical fiber without mechanical vibrations and, in some instances without moving parts, by using waveplates can be advantageous in some instances.
  • One embodiment of the current invention produces a substantially uniform flat-top beam (i.e., illumination/excitation area or footprint) by mixing the modes of the multimode optical fiber using a rotating λ/2 waveplate (retarding plate). The spatial content of the modes depends on the state of polarization of the input light. As polarization is changed, the spatial content is changed. Thus, the position of interference minima and maxima changes as the polarization of the input beam is changed. If the waveplate is rotated at an angular frequency that is faster than image acquisition time, then a spatially uniform image can be produced in the timescale of the observation. Thus, in particular embodiments, the waveplate completes one or more rotation during a certain time period. The time period is, e.g., one during which an image is captured of the area illuminated by the light output (e.g., substrate areas of the flowcells in certain sequencing embodiments herein). Thus, in certain embodiments, the time period is equivalent to or substantially equivalent to the expose period for each image captured by a camera (e.g., a CCD camera in particular sequencing embodiments herein). It will be appreciated that such exposure times can vary from embodiment to embodiment, e.g., from less than 1 msec to over 1 hour or more depending upon the particular requirements of the embodiment (e.g., at least 1, 5, 10, 25, 50, 100, 250, 500 or more µsec; at least 1, 5, 10, 25, 50, 100, 250, 500 or more msec; at least 1, 5, 10, 25, 50, 100, 250, 500 or more seconds, etc.). For the cameras used herein, the exposure time may be 50-500 milliseconds. In certain embodiments the waveplates can rotate less than or more than a full rotation during the time period, thus, in some embodiments, aliasing can also be included.
  • While the rotation of the polarization can be accomplished by a number of ways, typical embodiments rotate the waveplate. In particular embodiments herein, a λ/2 waveplate (see waveplate 3800 in Figure 38) in a suitable housing is rotated by a suitable DC motor or the like, operating at a speed fast enough so that a spatially substantially uniform image is produced during the appropriate image capture time. Other embodiments comprise modified waveplate(s) which consist of several sections of oriented waveplates or smaller pieces, with the fast axis oriented in different directions (see waveplate 3900 in Figure 39). Since sections rotate the polarization in different ways/amounts, a much faster mixing of the modes can occur and the DC motor optionally does not rotate as fast as in the embodiments with several sections. In yet other embodiments, other devices, such as liquid crystals (such as, but not limited to, those manufactured by Meadowlark Optics (Frederick, CO)) can be used to rotate the polarization of the laser. With such liquid crystals, the polarization can be rotated by varying the voltage across the device.
  • Figure 40 shows a schematic diagram representing an exemplary arrangement of an embodiment of the invention. In Figure 40 linearly polarized light 4100 (200mW, 532nm) from diode pumped solid state laser (4200) is attenuated by use of several OD filters. The intensity of the beam is further controlled by λ/2 waveplate 4900 (e.g., Casix, Fuzhou, Fujian, China) and polarizing beamsplitter cube 4300 (e.g., Thorlabs, Newton, NJ). In various embodiments, the entire laser intensity is not needed, thus, in the example described only about 0.1µW is used. Rotation of the waveplate 4900 allows a precise control of the input laser power while keeping the polarization fixed. The beam is then passed through second λ/2 retarding waveplate 4400 and steered by two mirrors 4500 and 4600 into microscope objective 4700 (e.g., Nikon, 20x NA 0.3). The microscope objective reduces the beam to the required size to be accepted by multimode optical fiber, 4800 200µm core, 0.22NA (e.g., OZ optics, Ottawa, Canada). The output end of the fiber in the embodiment shown is placed directly on the chip of CCD camera 4905 (e.g., Cascade 512, Photometrics, Tucson, AZ). In the exemplary embodiment shown, the camera was operated in frame transfer mode and exposures of 100 ms were adequate to capture the beam profile as explained herein.
  • In various embodiments, the current invention, no matter the overall system with which it is used, can comprise different waveplates (e.g., different in terms of type, placement, arrangement, construction, etc.), different mirrors and beam splitters (e.g., different in terms of type, location, angle, etc.). Thus, different embodiments can comprise, e.g., λ/2 waveplates, λ/4 waveplates (e.g., when the input polarization is circular), λ/n waveplates of other specific retardation, etc., and can comprise at least 1 waveplate, at least 2 waveplates, at least 3 waveplates, or at least 5 or more waveplates in various arrangements. The waveplates of the invention are not necessarily limited by their construction. Thus, solid crystal (e.g., crystal quartz, or any other appropriate substance) and liquid crystal waveplates are included herein.
  • While the current embodiment includes, and is described throughout in terms of its interaction with, nucleic acid sequencing systems (e.g., various sequencing by synthesis configurations as described herein), it will be appreciated by those of skill in the art that the current invention is also applicable to a wide range of other uses/systems. Thus, the embodiments can include systems comprising one or more waveplate (typically rotating) that mixes the optic modes of a multimode optical fiber in order to produce a spatially substantially uniform image or output in a desired timeframe (e.g., such as during the image capture time for a camera or the like). The current waveplate aspects can optionally be utilized with systems, such as those tracking fluorescence on a plate or microarray or the like, that is not a sequencing reaction. Correspondingly, the waveplate aspects can also include methods to create a substantially uniform image or output from a multimode optic fiber in a desired timeframe by passing the optic modes of the fiber through one or more waveplate (typically rotating and typically rotating at a speed faster than the image capture time or desired timeframe).
  • Various images obtained from exposure of a camera from such exemplary embodiments are shown in Figure 41. From a single exposure, the prominent regions of bright and dark pixels are evident in Figure 41A. The bright/dark images result from constructive and destructive interference of various modes that are present in the multimode optical fiber. Rotation of the waveplates results in spatial redistribution of the dark and bright regions as shown in the series of images in Figure 41B. In such Figures, each image was taken at a different waveplate setting. As mentioned previously, if the waveplate is rotated faster than the image acquisition time, then the spatial profile is averaged and uniform smoothing of the image results. Such uniform smoothing is comparable to obtaining a large number of images and averaging them. Figures 41C and 41D show a single image with its line profile (41C) and an average of 54 images with associated line profile (41D). Figure 42, shows the substantial uniformity of the footprint produced by use of the waveplate(s).
  • Other methods of ensuring that the optical beam is uniform over the imaging footprint include the use of solenoids, rotation of the light beam in an electric or magnetic field using Faraday or Pockel cells, and reimaging the light after it has gone through a diffuser. The diffuser can be a holographic diffuser that would superimpose light waves originating at the end of the fiber (if fiber coupled) or at the laser (if no fiber were present) in such a way that the waves superimpose and produce the required beam shape. One such example is a diffuser with an intensity profile of sinc(x)^2 (sine is sin(x)/x) which will transform a gauss beam into a top-hat beam.
  • The various mode scrambling aspects herein can optionally be controlled/manipulated through the one or more computer component and are typically coordinated/synched with the light illumination and light detection components (also typically by the computer aspects herein).
  • Devices for Detecting Fluorescence
  • There are numerous devices for detecting fluorescence, for example photodiodes and cameras, that can comprise the detection/detector component(s) of the current invention. In some embodiments herein, the detector component can comprise a 1 mega pixel CCD-based optical imaging system such as a 1024 x 1024 back thinned CCD camera with 8 µm pixels, which at 40x magnification can optionally image an area of 0.33 x 0.33 mm per tile using a laser spot size of 0.5 x 0.5 mm (e.g., a square spot, or a circle of 0.5 mm diameter, or an elliptical spot, etc.). The cameras can optionally have more or less than 1 million pixels, for example a 4 mega pixel camera can be used. In many embodiments, it is desired that the readout rate of the camera should be as fast as possible, for example the transfer rate can be 10 MHz or higher, for example 20 or 30 MHz. More pixels generally mean that a larger area of surface, and therefore more sequencing reactions, can be imaged simultaneously for a single exposure. This has the advantage of requiring fewer stage moves and filter wheel changes, and helps to speed up imaging. In particular embodiments, the CCD camera/TIRF lasers herein are capable of collecting about 6400 images to interrogate 1600 tiles (since images are optionally done in 4 different colors with optionally different filters in place) per cycle. For a 1 Mega pixel CCD, certain images optionally can contain between about 5,000 to 50,000 randomly spaced unique nucleic acid clusters (i.e., images upon the flowcell surface). The theoretical density of resolvable clusters per unit area (or image) is dependant of the size of the clusters, as shown in Figure 29 which shows a IMpix image of the number of detected clusters as a function of total cluster number and minimum cluster area. At an imaging rate of 2 seconds per tile for the four colors, and a density of 25000 clusters per tile, the systems herein can optionally quantify about 45 million features per hour. At a faster imaging rate, and higher cluster density, the imaging rate can be significantly improved. For example at the maximum readout rate of a 20 MHz camera, and a resolved cluster every 20 pixels, the readout can be 1 million clusters per second. The instrument can be configured to have more than a single camera. The light can be split to simultaneously image two colors onto two cameras, or even four colors onto four cameras. If four cameras are used in parallel, it is thus possible to sequence 1 million bases per second, or 86.4 billion bases per day.
  • There are two ways of splitting up the optical signals for a two camera system. If two lasers are used, there may be a red excitation and a green excitation, with half the emission light split towards each camera. Alternatively both lasers may be used in both illumination cycles, and the light may pass through a suitable dichroic mirror, so sending the red light in one direction, and the green light in a different direction, as shown in Figure 36. Such system prevents the signal losses associated with beam splitting, but does mean that two of the dyes are exposed to the laser before their intensity is recorded. In some such embodiments, the excitation blocker, e.g., as shown in Figure 36 can comprise a dual notch filter (e.g., 532 and 660 nm). A picture of an instrument with two detection cameras 3700 and two fluidics systems 3701 (and two flowcells 3702) is shown in Figure 37.
  • A "tile" herein is functionally equivalent to the image size mapped onto the substrate surface. Tiles can be, e.g., 0.33 mm2, 0.5 mm2, 1 mm2, 2 mm2 etc, although the size of the tile will depend to a large extent on the number and size of pixels on the camera and the desired level of magnification. Also, it will be appreciated that the tile does not have to equal the same size or shape as the illumination footprint from the laser (or other light source), although this can be advantageous if the minimization of photobleaching is desired.
  • As stated previously, in the various embodiments herein, the camera/laser systems collect fluorescence from 4 different fluorescent dyes (i.e., one for each nucleotide base type added to the flowcell). Again, additional material on other aspects of, and other concepts regarding, SBS sequencing can be found in applicants' co-pending applications, for example WO04018497 , WO04018493 and US7057026 (nucleotides), WO05024010 and WO06120433 (polymerases), WO05065814 (surface attachment techniques), and WO 9844151 , WO06064199 and WO07010251 (cluster preparation and sequencing).
  • Figures 1 and 13-16 show various possible configurations of the cameras and lasers of the present invention, including a backlight design, a TIRF Imaging configuration, a laser focusing configuration, a white-light viewing configuration, and an alternative laser focusing design. The white light excitation source is optional, and can be used as well as, or instead of, the excitation lasers. Figure 1 shows the backlight design system whilst recording an image in the TIRF imaging configuration. The configuration in Figure 1 for the TIRF imaging is optionally a configuration of the backlight design setup shown in Figure 13. In Figure 1, one of the two lasers (in laser assembly 160) is used to illuminate the sample (in flowcell 110), and a single one of the four emission filters (in filter switching assembly 145) is selected to record a single emission wavelength and to cut out any stray laser light. During imaging, both focus laser (150) and optional white light lamp (165) do not illuminate the sample as they are either blocked with a shutter or switched off. Laser illumination 101 and illumination from the flowcell up through the lens objective and camera 102 are also shown. Figure 13 shows all the components of the system in the backlight design but without the specific TIRF imaging configuration. Cf. Figures 1 and 13. Thus Figure 13 shows: fluid delivery module 1300, flowcell 1310, waste valve 1320, temperature actuator 1330, heating/cooling component (e.g., Peltier) 1335, camera (e.g., CCD camera) 1340, lens objective 1342, filter switching assembly 1345, focusing laser assembly 1350, excitation lasers assembly 1360, low watt lamp 1365, precision XY stage 1370, focus (z-axis) device 1375, mirror 1380, "reverse" dichroic 1385, and laser fiber optic 1390.
  • Figure 14 shows a similar system as that in Figure 1, but in the laser focusing configuration where the excitation lasers (in laser assembly 1460) and optional white light 1465 are switched off. Focusing laser 1450 is on and shines into the system, hits beam splitter 1485 (e.g., a pick-off mirror 1% beam splitter) which direct a faint beam 1402 down the objective to hit a small spot on the sample (in flowcell 1410). The scattered light from the sample returns up objective (1442) through an empty slot in filter wheel switching assembly 1445 and is imaged by CCD camera 1440. The position of the spot on the camera is used to ensure the sample is at the right distance from the objective, and therefore the image will be in focus. The numbering of the elements in Figure 14 is similar to that of the elements in Figure 13, but numbered as "14" rather than "13," e.g., 1460 corresponds to a similar element as 1360, etc. The autofocus system is described in more detail below.
  • Figure 15 shows the optional white light viewing configuration, where focus laser 1550 and illumination lasers 1560 are off. In such configuration the white light from low watt lamp 1565 goes into the system as beam 1503 and is imaged directly on the camera. Here too, the numbering of elements, except for beam 1503, etc., follows that of Figures 13 and 14. Figure 16 shows an alternative focus configuration where the system contains second focusing camera 1641, which can be a quadrant detector, PSD, or similar detector to measure the location of the scattered beam reflected from the surface. This configuration allows for focus control concurrent with data collection. The focus laser wavelength is optionally longer than the reddest dye emission filter.
  • Figures 17-19 show various schematics for beam shape and dimensions for TIRF assays carried out with use of the current systems herein, while Figure 20 displays an optional embodiment of a TIRF prism for use with the systems herein. Thus it will be appreciated that the shape (e.g., round, square, etc.) of the laser beams and/or of the imaging areas illuminated by the laser beams can optionally vary between different embodiments. Figure 17 shows the dimensions and geometries of the beam as it emerges from the fiber. In order to illuminate a circle on the substrate, the beam must be projected from the fiber as an ellipse since the beam hits the substrate surface at an angle to the normal. Edge view 1700 of circle projected by ellipse 1730 (e.g., an elliptical beam shape required at fiber exit (looking down fiber centerline at 22°). The prism face partial outline 1710 is not to scale and the edge view 1720 of ellipse 1730 is shown on the minor axis. Likewise in order to illuminate a square on the substrate, the beam must be projected onto the surface as a rectangle, as shown in Figure 18. In Figure 18, rectangle 1830 is shown. A rec-elliptical beam shape is required at fiber exit (looking down fiber centerline at 22°). Edge view 1800 of the square projected by rectangle 1830 is also indicated as is prism face partial outline 1830 (not to scale) and edge view 1820 of rec-ellipse 1830 (minor axis).
  • As shown in Figure 19, the prism is designed to allow the imaging beam to hit the substrate surface at approximately 68° (relative to the normal) to achieve a total internal reflection and generate an evanescent beam that excites the fluorophores on the surface. To control the path of the beam through the prism, and therefore keep the illumination footprint directly over a stationary objective lens as the flowcell moves, the prism may have a geometry where the angle of the prism to the surface is also 68°, thereby ensuring that the light always hits the prism at 90°. The desired geometry of the prism is more fully described in application WO03062897 , and the exemplary size and geometry is shown in Figure 20, etc.
  • Beam shape of the lasers herein is optionally controlled by polishing the multimode fiber output end in order to create, e.g., a square beam. See, e.g., Figures 21. Figure 21 shows imaged beam results from such polishing. In other embodiments, the beam is optionally round. In some instances, the beam properties may be a Gaussian profile with the following properties: a nominal image size of radius 0.17 mm, a maximal spot size of 0.25 mm radius, and 0.32 mm as the point after which there is effectively no laser intensity. In certain embodiments, the beam intensity is greater than 90% maximum intensity at all positions within the nominal image size; 80% maximum intensity at all positions within the maximal spot size, and no greater than 1% of maximal intensity outside of 0.32 radius. In various embodiments (in the absence of a dynamic mode scrambler), the intensity at any point does not vary by more than 5% RMS within the timescale of 1s-1h and the variation in the total (integrated) laser power is not more than 3% RMS measured over 24 hours.
  • Illumination Systems
  • A variety of illumination systems may be used in devices according to the present invention. The illumination systems can comprise lamps and/or lasers. The systems can contain one or more illumination lasers of different wavelengths. For example the systems herein may contain two lasers of 532 nm and 660 nm, although lasers with other wavelengths may also be used. Additionally, in various embodiments, the lasers in the systems herein are actively temperature controlled to 0.1C, have TTL modulation for the 660 nm laser diode with rise time less than 100 ms; have integrated manual shutters for fast modulation of the 532 nm laser, have integrated beam shaping optics to ensure the optimum beam aspect ratio is maintained at the instrument interface to maximize signal to noise ratio, have integrated mode scrambler to reduce ripple on the output of the multi-mode fiber, and have minimal heat generation. The shutters and TTL modulation are used to ensure that the illumination is only on the sample surface whilst the camera is recording images. Illumination of fluorophores can cause photobleaching, and therefore exposure of substrates to the laser when not needed is generally minimized, especially before the images are recorded.
  • Figures 22A and B give various filter wheel arrangements of certain embodiments for use with various optic configurations. The use of a two laser excitation system to detect four fluorophores means that two of the fluorophores are excited away from their maximum absorbtion wavelength, as shown in figure 22B. If the emission filters used in all four channels were the same band width, then the two fluorophores nearest the 532 and 660 nm lasers would be significantly brighter than the two fluorophores excited further from the lasers. However, this factor can be negated by changing the bandwidth of the filters. For example, as shown in figure 22B, in the case of the 532 nm laser, dyes that absorb at for example 530 and 560 nm can both be excited by the 532 laser. The use of a narrow filter close to the laser, for example a 560/20 that lets light through from 550-570 nm only allows the light from the 532 nm dye through. The use of a wider bandpass filter further away from the laser, for example a 610/75 that allows light through from 572 nm to 647 nm lets through the light from both fluorophores. The intensity of the 532 fluorophore through the 560/20 filter is similar to the intensity of the 560 fluorophore through the 610/75 filter. Thus the two fluorophores can be clearly distinguished using a single laser and two emission filters.
  • The effect is not wavelength specific, and can be performed using any excitation wavelength. The same effect can therefore be achieved using the red laser. Two fluorophores that absorb at 650 nm and 680 nm can be distinguished using a narrow filter close to the laser (for example a 682/22), and a broader filter further away, for example a 700 long pass. Again the intensities of the two dyes through their respective filters is similar, whilst the signal from the 680 dye in the 682/22 filter is much reduced. Both dyes emit into the 700 long pass channel, but the signals can clearly be determined due to the different level of emission in the narrow filter. The adaptation of laser wavelengths, fluorophore selections and filter bandwidths can be used to obtain a set of four fluorophores using any number of wavelengths, and the intensities of the emission through each channel can be normalized using the bandwidth of the filters to control how much light is transmitted.
  • Figure 23 shows a nominal design for an embodiment of the 30x system ray trace, while Figure 24 shows the 30x imaging performance. The imaging performance of the system is dependent on the magnification of the objective lens, and the other lenses in the system. A smaller magnification will allow a larger area of the substrate to be imaged, but at a cost of resolution of closely packed clusters and the brightness of each cluster. A preferred magnification is optionally between 10X-40X, for example 20X or 30X. The objective can be custom designed to allow diffraction limited imaging to be retained when viewing fluorescence objects through a non-standard geometry (for example thicker glass substrates) and hence removing the otherwise present spherical aberration. The objective lens may be connected to the detector via a further tube lens.
  • Autofocus System
  • In particular embodiments, the systems herein can comprise components to aid in proper focusing of imaging clusters. In general, in particular embodiments herein, in an autofocus set up, an autofocus laser beam shines down to a sample through an objective lens, reflects from the flowcell surface, goes back to the lens and then to the camera, thus creating a spot on the image. When the objective is moved up/down with a fixed sample, the spot centroids align around a straight line on the image (calibration curve). Displacement "dr" along this calibration line is proportional to the change "d(z-zf)" in the distance between the objective and the focal plane. In many embodiments, before the run, the software establishes the orientation of the calibration line (its slope) and the "sensitivity": dz/dr (nm/pixel). This is accomplished by taking 21 images with the step of 1000 nm in z-direction around focus position which is established visually. The software also can require the x, y pixel coordinates of the spot when the sample is in focus: xf, yf. this is determined from the first (central) focus image from the set of the 21 calibration images. For example, the devices herein optionally comprise an auto focus function objective achieving 100 nm resolution mounted with up to 50 mm Z axis motion. The objective lens can optionally move vertically in relation to the substrate, and the illumination laser can be coupled to the Z axis motion such that the illumination inputs also move in relation to the substrate. For embodiments having autofocus capability, an autofocus beam is optionally sent along the edge of the microscope objective lens (optionally as far off-axis as possible in order to correspond to maximum sensitivity). The autofocus beam can come from the illumination lasers, or from a separate source that is optionally a different wavelength than the illumination laser, for example 488 nm, 630 nm or an infra-red laser of 700 nm or redder. The reflected beam is then optionally monitored by either a quad cell or by leakage through a dichroic beam splitter onto the fluorescence imaging camera. In such embodiments, the lens and camera are optionally the same as that used in the instrument (e.g., 20X lens). Similar autofocus systems which are optionally included within the current systems and devices have been previously described, for example in WO03060589 .
  • With particular autofocusing aspects herein, as the imaging plane moves with respect to the objective lens, the reflected monitoring beam also optionally moves laterally (i.e. dotted line is the in focus plane while the solid line represents an out of focus plane which gives rise to a lateral shift in the detected beam in Figure 25). The dichroic mirror chosen in such embodiments is usually one that reflects the autofocus beam. The small leakage that is actually transmitted (c.a. <5%) is more than adequate to observe on a CCD camera with no emission filter in the emission path. Figure 26 shows sample photographs of both out of focus and in focus images where the spot is seen on the imaging camera. The lower images show the detected autofocus spot on the imaging camera. The spot can also be seen on a separate detector, as shown in Figure 27.
  • In embodiments comprising autofocus aspects, the computer component optionally comprises an autofocus algorithm. Such algorithms optionally aid in the determination of the correct focus (e.g., by monitoring the above measurements and adjusting accordingly). The autofocus spot can be made to move in a 1D manner e.g. in just the y-direction rather than x & y, thus simplifying the procedure. The focus position of the objective lens is assumed to move in the z-direction.
  • The first step in some embodiments of the autofocus analysis is a "Setup Response function" wherein positions of the autofocus spot (y1, y2....yn) are measured on the imaging camera for several positions of the objective lens (z1,z2...zn). Typically 5 positions are adequate. Shown in Figure 27 is an analysis with just 3 positions. The movement of the reflected spot is shown as imaged on a fluorescence camera in the lower panels. For each Z plane there is an associated y-position of the reflected spot (centroid) on the camera. These five data points (z1, y1), (z2, y2), (z3, y3), (z4, y4), (z5, y5) can be described by a line. z = my 0 + c
    Figure imgb0001
  • The m and c values are given from the data points from least squares fits as: c = z . y 2 y . yz 5 y 2 y 2
    Figure imgb0002
    m = 5 . yz y . z 5 y 2 y 2
    Figure imgb0003
    y 0 = c m
    Figure imgb0004
    Thus, from the 5 data points, the values of c, m and y0 are determined giving a known response function.
  • The next step in such embodiments of the autofocus analysis comprises "Calculate newC (for out of focus position)" wherein for each position c is constant, i.e. doesn't change for an out of focus or in focus position. However, it does change for different positions. Hence as the stage moves to a new position NewC is calculated from the changed Z and y values as: newC = Z measured m . y measured
    Figure imgb0005
  • The third step in the process is to use newC to calculate required Z position (newZ) to get in focus y position (y0). It is known that newC = newZ m . y 0
    Figure imgb0006
    Hence newZ = newC + m . y 0
    Figure imgb0007
    m & y0 are measured from step 1 (once per chip). newC is measured from step 2 (every position). Hence newZ can be calculated.
  • Another aspect in auto focus components of the invention comprises laser pointing stability requirements. To assess how much pointer error can be tolerated in the auto focus laser, one can view the objective as a simple thin lens with the proper focal length as shown in the exaggerated drawing in Figure 28.
  • Simple geometry y then yields that the angle Φ that would cause the auto focus laser beam to appear shifted by one pixel is simply at a (Δ/F) which is approximately Δ/F for small angles.
  • For a 20X objective (with the tube lens relay lens combination present in some embodiments) the pixel size is roughly 0.3 µm. The focal length of that lens is 10 mm. Hence the error angle that corresponds to 1 pixel is approximately 30 µrad. Some embodiments of the system have their auto focus set for a sensitivity of about 4 pixel shift of the auto focus laser spot per micron of z motion.
  • Assuming that 0.5 µm of focus error (corresponding to two pixels shift in the position of the laser spot) can be tolerated, it is seen that the biggest pointing change that can tolerate for the auto focus laser is 60 µrad.
  • To meet that sort of stability requirement over normal room temperature variations, it is highly recommendable to use a fiber optically coupled laser. Unless a solid state laser is very carefully temperature controlled, it will be difficult to maintain this sort of pointing accuracy within a reasonable ambient temperature spec range (e.g., 20-30C.).
  • To provide additional information and theory in regard to focus tracking algorithms, a more detailed example of implementing the autofocus system is given below.
  • The first step in some embodiments of the focus tracking procedure is to obtain the image of the autofocus laser spot on an imaging device, which may be the imaging camera. Data from this primary spot is extracted in two passes-a first coarse pass that determines the approximate position and size of the spot, followed by a second fine pass that determines the spot boundaries correctly before determining the COL (Center of Light) and other spot features. The first pass analysis can be performed in 5 steps: (1) the 16-bit image is converted to an 8-bit image, with maximum of the image set to 255, minimum of image set to 0, and all other grayscale values linearly in between; (2) The Picture Quality of the image is computed. Picture quality is defined as the average of the normalized autocorrelation of the image with itself with shifts of unit pixel to the left and unit pixel down. If the image is noisy, then since noise does not correlate with itself, this measure will be low; (3) Next, this image is thresholded at 128. Anything above this value will be regarded as foreground, while anything below this level will be seen as background. Starting from the grayscale 255 (i.e. the hotspots), region-grow to find all 8-connected foreground components; (4) Of all these candidate foreground components, the component with the highest average brightness is chosen as "the" component specifying the position and approximate size of the primary spot; and (5) The bounding box of this component is computed.
  • The second (fine) pass analysis is performed in three steps: (1) The subimage corresponding to twice the area of the bounding box is cut out from the 8-bit grayscale image. This makes the population of foreground and background pixels approximately equal, thereby making it easier for standard image histogram based thresholding techniques to work reliably; (2) The histogram of the subimage is computed and the "best" grayscale threshold that separates foreground from background is determined. The threshold used is called "Otsu's Threshold" (see IEEE Trans. Systems, Man, and Cybernetics, vol. 9, pp. 62-66, 1979, or Computer and Robot Vision, .); and (3) The image is thresholded at the Otsu threshold and the 8-connected foreground component is determined. This is the primary spot blob on which every subsequent feature extraction is carried out.
  • An additional pass can be carried out to extract the position of the secondary spot. Four steps can be done to carry out such additional pass: (1) The 8-bit image (from the First Pass) is thresholded at a low threshold of 16; (2) It should be noted that at this lower threshold, the number of pixels (area) of the primary spot component increases. This area of the primary spot is recorded and is used to determine how tight or diffuse it is; (3) The component (of sufficient size) closest in distance to the primary spot component is identified as the secondary spot; (4) The geometric centroid of the secondary spot is recorded.
  • Center of Light determination
  • To determine the Center of Light (COL) for autofocusing, ( x , y ) is denoted as the center of light of the primary spot. Then this is computed for the primary spot blob as: x = g i x i g i and y = g i y i g i ,
    Figure imgb0008
    where the summation is taken over all pixels i in the blob having image based coordinates (xi , yi ) and grayscales gi (above threshold).
  • Other Spot Features
  • In addition to Picture Quality and the Center of Light, the list of features calculated for the primary spot blob includes Area which is a measure of how diffuse (non-tight) the primary blob is. This is set to the area (count in pixels) of the primary blob at the low threshold divided by its area at the Otsu threshold. Other features calculated include Volume (the average brightness, above threshold × Area of the primary blob); Average Brightness, which is the sum of the gray values of the pixels in the blob divided by its area; and Maximum Brightness: Maximum gray value.
  • The extracted data can then be used to calibrate the Z focus, and thereby determine how much to move the objective in order for the image to be in focus. The overview of the calibration procedure is as follows: (1) Calibration for the Z focus is done (with user help) at the beginning of every run; (2) At the beginning of calibration the user makes sure that the image is in focus, i.e. at the focal plane. He/she thus sets the Z focus point zF ; (3) This embodiment of autofocus relies on user input and the coordinates of the autofocus laser spot on an image; (4) As z is changed during the Calibration process, the spot moves in linear proportion to the change of z along a line.
  • The calibration algorithmic procedure begins with a sequence of Center of Lights (x, y) extracted from the sequence of autofocus spot images acquired as z is changed. Ideally these points when graphed should all fall perfectly on a straight line, shown below.
    Figure imgb0009
  • Unfortunately, because of various noise sources, both physical and computational, the points are displaced from the ideal straight line, as shown:
    Figure imgb0010
  • Therefore an XY Principal Component Analysis (see e.g. I.T. Jolliffe, Principal Component Analysis, 2nd ed. Springer Series in Statistics, 2002.) based regression is performed between X and Y, leading to a new coordinates system R and Q as shown:.
    Figure imgb0011
    It should be noted that: (1) Origin of the (R, Q) system is at the center of mass of the ( x , y) points; (2) A best fitting (principal component) line defines the R axis; and (3) The orthogonal line to the R axis defines the Q axis. The model calls for high correlation between X and Y. The Q coordinate values can therefore be regarded as error "residuals" from the best fitting line-the idea is to get rid of these residuals and correct the observations.
  • Finally, since the model calls for a linear relationship between the spatial coordinates and the z values (as shown), a linear regression is performed between r and z to determine the coefficients of this line:
    Figure imgb0012
  • Additionally autofocus tracking can involve various training of regression engines.
  • Training the XY PCA Regression Engine
  • Input: A sequence of Center of Lights (x, y) extracted from the sequence of autofocus spot images acquired as z is changed.
    Output: The PCA Regression Coefficients, i.e. transformation to the (R, Q) coordinate space.
    Description: Perform Principal Component Analysis and save the coefficients. Also, given the centroid position of the secondary spot, determine whether it is to the left or the right of the primary spot along the principal axis.
  • Training the RZ Linear Regression Engine
  • Input: The r coordinates obtained from the PCA Regression, the corresponding z values, and the Z focus point zF .
    Output: The Linear Regression Coefficients relating (z - zF ) to r.
    Description: Perform Linear Regression Analysis and save the coefficients.
  • Training the Outlier Detector
  • An outlier detection scheme is used to warn the presence of a bubble or to flag a filter wheel problem.
    Input: The q coordinates obtained from the PCA Regression, along with the spot features for every spot in the calibration sequence are used to train a classifier to detect outlier spots.
    Output: Internal settings of the Outlier Detector.
    Description: For every feature φ, the mean µφ and standard deviation σφ is calculated from the spots used during calibration. The general idea is that a spot would be declared an outlier spot if the feature φ is outside the bounds of µφ ± 3σφ . However in the current implementation only the Volume and Area features are used in this way-in fact, only the upper bounds are currently used for these two features. Special bounds are set to override these values for both the picture quality and the q residue feature. For the picture quality, a lower bound is used. For the residue, an upper bound is used.
  • Running the Autofocus system
  • A run starts from an image of the autofocus laser spot and uses the coefficients of the transformations learned during the calibration process to make the best estimate for the z displacement required to move to focus.
    Input: An image of the autofocus laser spot.
    Output: (z - zF ) to move to focus. Also provides recommendation of whether or not to move based upon outlier detection.
    Description: Derives best estimate of (z - zF ) using:
    1. The spot extraction algorithm. ,
    2. The PCA based XY Regression coefficients.
    3. The Linear RZ Regression coefficients. In one implementation, the outlier detection scheme allows a move only in the case of a large q residual. In case of low picture quality, high volume, or high area, it recommends non-movement.
    If during long periods of z non-movement, as may be triggered by large bubbles/contaminations in the flowcell, the surface of the flowcell drifts enough to make the secondary spot appear locally in all respects to the primary spot seen in calibration, such algorithm would latch onto such spot for the rest of the cycle even though the bubble/contamination ceased to exist inside the flowcell. In order to recover from such problem, the following steps can be taken: In case a move is recommended, a further check can be performed to see whether a secondary spot exists in the direction opposite to the one where training says it ought to be. If it does, then a move can be recommended to this sport using the PCA based XY Regression and the Linear RZ Regression coefficients.
  • Computer
  • As noted above, the various components of the present system are coupled to an appropriately programmed processor or computer that functions to instruct the operation of these instruments in accordance with preprogrammed or user input instructions, receive data and information from these instruments, and interpret, manipulate and report this information to the user. As such, the computer is typically appropriately coupled to these instruments/components (e.g., including an analog to digital or digital to analog converter as needed).
  • The computer optionally includes appropriate software for receiving user instructions, either in the form of user input into set parameter fields, e.g., in a GUI, or in the form of preprogrammed instructions, e.g., preprogrammed for a variety of different specific operations (e.g., auto focusing, SBS sequencing, etc.). The software then converts these instructions to appropriate language for instructing the correct operation to carry out the desired operation (e.g., of fluid direction and transport, autofocusing, etc.).
  • For example, the computer is optionally used to direct a fluid flow component to control fluid flow, e.g., through a variety of tubing. The fluid flow component optionally directs the movement of the appropriate buffers, nucleotides, enzymes, etc., into and through the flowcell.'
  • The computer also optionally receives the data from the one or more sensors/detectors included within the system, and interprets the data, either provides it in a user understood format, or uses that data to initiate further controller instructions, in accordance with the programming, e.g., such as in monitoring and control of flow rates, temperatures, and the like.
  • In the present invention, the computer typically includes software for the monitoring and control of materials in the flowcells. Additionally the software is optionally used to control excitation of the fluorescent labels and monitoring of the resulting emissions. The computer also typically provides instructions, e.g., to the heating/cooling component and autofocus system, etc.
  • Any controller or computer optionally includes a monitor, which is often a cathode ray tube ("CRT") display, a flat panel display (e.g., active matrix liquid crystal display, liquid crystal display), or the like. Data produced from the current systems, e.g., nucleic acid sequence results is optionally displayed in electronic form on the monitor. Additionally, the data, e.g., light emission profiles from the nucleic acid arrays, or other data, gathered from the system can be outputted in printed form. The data, whether in printed form or electronic form (e.g., as displayed on a monitor), can be in various or multiple formats, e.g., curves, histograms, numeric series, tables, graphs and the like.
  • Computer circuitry is often placed in a box which includes, e.g., numerous integrated circuit chips, such as a microprocessor, memory, interface circuits. The box also optionally includes a hard disk drive, a floppy disk drive, a high capacity removable drive such as a writeable CD-ROM, and other common peripheral elements. Inputting devices such as a keyboard or mouse optionally provide for input from a user and for user selection of sequences to be compared or otherwise manipulated in the relevant computer system.
  • Exemplary use and Component Variation
  • The SBS systems herein, in many embodiments, comprise CCD/TIRF laser based excitation and imaging subsystems which can image millions of nucleic acid clusters per sample (typically within a flowcell) and which can detect each of four fluorescent dyes (one for each of the four bases). The SBS chemistry components, e.g.,, nucleotides, WO04018497 , WO04018493 and US7057026 , polymerases WO05024010 and WO06120433 , surface attachment techniques, WO05065814 , cluster preparation and sequencing, WO 9844151 , WO06064199 and WO07010251 , are compatible with the channeled flowcell components herein, etc. The computer or data analysis system aspects of the system are optionally capable of processing thousands of images per hour into sequence information
  • As an overview, in particular examples of sequencing by SBS, genomic DNA is randomly fragmented, end capped with known sequences, and covalently attached to a substrate (such as the channel in a flowcell), e.g., by hybridization to a covalent primer. From such attached DNA, an array of nucleic acid clusters is created, as described in WO9844141 and WO07010251 . SBS analysis (e.g., using the systems and devices herein) can generate a series of images of the clusters, which can then be processed to read the sequence of the nucleic acids in each cluster which can then be aligned against a reference sequence to determine sequence differences, a larger overall sequence, or the like. Algorithms for the alignment of short reads of nucleic acids are described in WO05068089 .
  • As described above, each sequencing cycle will include a round of incorporation onto the growing nucleic acid chain. Such cycle is typically done by an addition of all four dNTPs, each modified so that each base is identifiable by a unique fluorophore. Additionally, the triphosphates are modified at the 3' position so that extension is controlled and not more than a single base can be added to each molecule in each cycle. The generic concept of performing clusters amplified from a single template molecule on a random array, and the subsequent sequencing of said array is shown in Figures 30-32, which schematically illustrate various aspects of sequencing procedures and methods carried out by the systems herein. For example, the basic overview steps of formation of nucleic acid clusters, the cluster arrays produced (and a comparison of such cluster arrays against a more "traditional" array) and an outline of the sequencing methodology are all presented. Figure 30 shows the basic outlines of nucleic acid cluster creation and sequencing while Figure 31 compares nucleic acid density between an array (on left) and on a nucleic acid cluster substrate such as those capable of use with the systems/devices of the invention (on right). Figure 32 gives a cartoon outlining the SBS sequencing procedure, e.g., as done by embodiments of the invention.
  • After the incorporation step wherein a fluorescently labeled nucleotide is bound to the nucleic acid of the members of the clusters through a cleavable linker, the channels of the flowcell are washed out by the fluid flow subsystem in order to remove any unincorporated nucleosides and enzyme.
  • Next, a read step is performed by the system, whereby the identity of the individual labels (read as a group in each cluster) incorporated in the incorporation step is recorded using optical microscopy and the corresponding base incorporated is noted. The sequencing system can read the four different fluorophores using two lasers at distinct wavelengths via total internal reflection microscopy (TIRF) and four distinct emission filters at different parts of the spectrum. The images are recorded onto a CCD camera and reported into the attached computer module.
  • After the specific incorporation is read, a deprotection step removes the labeling moiety and block from the surface bound DNA. The deprotection allows repetition of the above incorporation and reading steps until sufficient cycles of information are obtained to uniquely place the sequence of each nucleic acid cluster (present on the flowcell) in its genomic context. For example, in the case of the human genome this will be >16 cycles, e.g., about 25-50 cycles. The images can be stored off line, or processed in real time such that the individual bases are read during the sequencing process. Processing the images provides a database of a sequence read from every cluster, where each cluster is derived from a random position somewhere in entire sample (e.g., a genome). Thus during the course of the procedure, a database of millions of sequence reads covering every part of the genome is typically constructed. Such database can be, e.g., compared with a database of every sequence derived from a reference sequence, etc. In various embodiments, image analysis, sequence determination, and/or sequence alignment are optionally performed "off-line" after the fluorescent images are captured. Such procedures are also optionally performed by a computer separate from the one present in the current systems.
  • As mentioned throughout, the current invention can vary between embodiments (e.g., in number and type of components or subsystems). For example, in one embodiment of the invention (embodiment "b"), the components can comprise: illumination lasers (used to excite the fluorophores in the sequencing reactions) of 532 and 660 nm each with 75 mW power (or optionally greater) that project as 0.5 mm circle on the bottom of the channel in a flowcell; a TIR prism of glass (68 deg or 71 deg); a glass flowcell with channels of 1×61 mm area having 8 channels that are 100 µm deep (39x1 mm usable or accessible for viewing); an objective lens in the camera component comprising a Nikon Plan Apo 20x, 0.75NA (corrected for glass thickness); emission filters comprising Bandpass filters of 557±11 nm, 615±40 nm, 684±11 nm, and 740±50nm (or optionally filters as shown, or similar to those shown, in Figure 22); relay optics comprising a Navitar 1.33x adapter for a net magnification of about 23x, or an unmagnified tube lens; and a digital CCD camera comprising a Photometrics Cascade 1Mpix or 1K camera, with a pixel size of 8 µm, and a readout rate of 10 MHz, and a microscope objective of 20x magnification with 0.75 NA (numerical aperture). The Cascade embodiment "b" can give a net performance of 0.35 mm field with approximately 0.8 µm optical resolution (somewhat larger than diffraction limit).
  • Such 1 Megapixel embodiments can illuminate a 0.5 mm circle and detect a 0.35 mm square inside it. The flowcell in such embodiments can have a total of 156 non-overlapping tiles in a channel or higher. The clusters can be on the order of 1 µm. The NA of the microscope can optionally give a PSF of approximately 0.6 µm at 700 nm. Thus, a "typical" cluster gets an apparent diameter of approximately 1.2 µm. In the image plane, 1 pixel represents approximately 0.35 µm, so a typical cluster would have about 3.5 pixels diameter. The area of a cluster is the about 9.25 pixels. Poisson distribution of 10 area pixel objects on 1 Mpixel CCD shows maximum of about 38,000 objects will be non-overlapping as shown in Figure 29. Figure 29 gives an example of information throughput from an exemplary configuration of a system of the invention. The number of detected clusters is a function of the total cluster number and the minimum cluster area.
  • For exemplary "b" embodiments, the resolution limit (using Rayleigh criterion) is about 0.6 µm and clusters are about 1 µm for an apparent size of about 1.2 µm. Pixels map to about 0.35 µm in image plane so a cluster is about 3.5 pixels across and about 10 pixels in area. For randomly distributed clusters, the maximum number of unconfused clusters in the 1 MPix camera will be about 38,000 in a 0.35 mm square tile. "b" flowcells accommodate 150 non-overlapping illumination tiles per channel for a total of 1200 tiles per flowcell. This is 45.6 M Bases per cycle and about 1 GBase in a 25 cycle run. Overlapping the illumination and closely packing the tiles means that 200 tiles can be imaged per channel, and therefore 1600 per flowcell.
  • For the "b" illumination subsystem throughput, the laser wavelengths are: green laser wavelength 532 nm; green laser power optionally 75 mW; red laser wavelength 660 nm; red laser power optionally 75 mW; projected TIRF beam diameter 0.5 mm; and allowed variation across beam 20%.
  • In another embodiment, (embodiment "g"), the system of the invention can comprise: illumination lasers of 532 and 660 nm, each with 500 mW power (ideally projected as 0.5 mm square), a TIR prism of glass (68 deg); a glass flowcell having 8 channels 100 µm deep and of 1 × 61 mm in area with a 50 mm usable; an objective lens comprising a Nikon Plan Fluor 40x, 0.6 NA adjustable collar, or custom 40x, 0.75 NA corrected for an SBS flowcell; emission filters comprising Bandpass filters of 557±11 nm, 615±40 nm, 684±11 nm, and 740±50 nm; image optics comprising an 150 mm achromatic doublet for system magnification of 30x; and a digital CCD camera comprising a Photometries CoolSNAP K4, 2048 by 2048 pixels, 4Mpix camera, 7.4 µm pixel size, 20 MHz readout. Such embodiment can give a net performance of 0.5 mm field with less than 0.7 µm diffraction limit. It can comprise a relay lens of 0.75× for total 30x system magnification.
  • In some such "g" embodiments, it is desired that a 0.5 mm square is uniformly illuminated and that the same 0.5 mm square is detected (2048 × 7.4 / 30000). The clusters on the flowcells herein can be as small as 0.5 µm. PSF at 700 nm is approximately 0.7 µm. Clusters thus appear as 0.86 µm where 1 pixel represents 0.25 µm. A typical cluster therefore is 3.5 pixels and the area of a cluster is 9.25 pixels. 4 Mpixel CCD gives a maximum of about 135,000 detectable non-overlapping clusters per tile.
  • The illumination footprint is four times larger, meaning a 4 time increase in laser powers is needed to obtain the same level of signal in the same exposure time. To minimize exposure times, the laser power can be increased further. Such a system is therefore capable of generating 2 billion bases of sequence per experiment, if the following parameters are used: Objective with numerical aperture 0.8; 20x magnification; 4 Mpixel camera; 760 µm × 760 µm illumination tiles; 1 imaging lane per flow channel; 48 tiles per lane; 8 channels per chip; clusters of average size 0.7 µm; and, read length of 40 bases. Therefore total throughput = 8 channels × 48 tiles × 135000 clusters/tile × 40 cycles = 2.07 billion bases (G).
  • Increasing the size of the flowcell to increase the numbers of tiles imaged, the density of clusters, or the read length, will enable improvements in the number of bases generated per flowcell. Two or four cameras can be mounted in parallel to obtain a system with two or four times the throughput. A two camera configuration is shown in Figures 36 and 37. The scanning time can be decreased using techniques such as Time Delay Integration (TDI), meaning that the surface is continually scanned rather than imaged in discrete tiles. The instrument can be configured to perform multiple chemistry steps with multiple fluidics systems coupled to a single optical system. In the single chemistry system, the optical system is not imaging whilst the chemistry steps are occurring. If the chemistry and imaging parts of the cycle take similar lengths, then for 50% of the time, the instrument is not recording data. If the scanning part of the system is further speeded up, then an even higher percentage of the experimental run time is spent performing chemistry. This can be alleviated if the system is configured such that multiple flowcells are processed simultaneously, with one flowcell always undergoing imaging. Schematic representations of a dual flowcell holder are shown in Figure 43.
  • Although the system as described is shown with the illumination from underneath, and the objective on top, the system as shown can be inverted to illuminate from the top, and have the detection system underneath. See above. The heating and illumination can be carried out from either face of the substrate, so that bottom side heating and top side illumination are also within the scope of the invention. The operation of systems within the scope of the inventions are further described in the following general methods.
  • Examples of using the system in sequencing
  • The following are examples of general techniques and the like (e.g., for nucleic acid cluster formation) which can optionally be applied in use with the systems of the invention. It will be appreciated that such descriptions and examples are not necessarily limiting upon the current systems and their use unless specifically stated to be so. The methods for forming and sequencing nucleic acid clusters are fully described in patent application WO07010251 , the protocols of which are incorporated herein by reference in their entirety, but some elements of these protocols are summarized below.
  • Preparation of Substrates and Formation of Nucleic Acid Clusters Acrylamide coating of glass chips
  • The solid supports used for attachment of nucleic acid to be sequenced are optionally 8-channel glass chips such as those provided by Silex Microsystems (Sweden). However, the experimental conditions and procedures are readily applicable to other solid supports as well. In some embodiments chips were washed as follows: neat Decon for 30 min, milliQ H2O for 30 min, NaOH IN for 15 min, milliQ H2O for 30 min, HCl 0.1N for 15 min, milliQ H2O for 30 min. The Polymer solution preparation entailed:
    For 10 ml of 2% polymerization mix.
    • 10 ml of 2% solution of acrylamide in milliQ H2O;
    • 165 µl of a 100mg/ml N-(5-bromoacetamidylpentyl) acrylamide (BRAPA) solution in DMF (23.5 mg in 235µl DMF);
    • 11.5 µl of TEMED; and,
    • 100 µl of a 50 mg/ml solution of potassium persulfate in milliQ H2O (20mg in 400µl H2O).
  • In such embodiments, the 10 ml solution of acrylamide was first degassed with argon for 15 min. The solutions of BRAPA, TEMED and potassium persulfate were successively added to the acrylamide solution. The mixture was then quickly vortexed and immediately used. Polymerization was then carried out for 1h 30 at RT. Afterwards the channels were washed with milliQ H2O for 30 min and filled with 0.1 M potassium phosphate buffer for storage until required.
  • Synthesis of N-(5-bromoacetamidylpentyl) acrylamide (BRAPA)
  • Figure imgb0013
  • N-Boc-1,5-diaminopentane toluene sulfonic acid was obtained from Novabiochem. The bromoacetyl chloride and acryloyl chloride were obtained from Fluka. All other reagents were Aldrich products.
    Figure imgb0014
  • To a stirred suspension of N-Boc-1,5-diaminopentane toluene sulfonic acid (5.2 g, 13.88 mmol) and triethylamine (4.83 ml, 2.5 eq) in THF (120 ml) at 0°C was added acryloyl chloride (1.13 ml, 1 eq) through a pressure equalized dropping funnel over a one hour period. The reaction mixture was then stirred at room temperature and the progress of the reaction checked by TLC (petroleum ether: ethyl acetate 1:1). After two hours, the salts formed during the reaction were filtered off and the filtrate evaporated to dryness. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (neat petroleum ether followed by a gradient of ethyl acetate up to 60%) to yield 2.56 g (9.98 mmol, 71 %) of product 2 as a beige solid. 1H NMR (400 MHz, d6-DMSO) : 1.20-1.22 (m, 2H, CH2), 1.29-1.43 (m, 13H, tBu, 2xCH2), 2.86 (q, 2H, J = 6.8 Hz and 12.9 Hz, CH2), 3.07 (q, 2H, J = 6.8 Hz and 12.9 Hz, CH2), 5.53 (dd, 1H, J = 2.3 Hz and 10.1 Hz, CH), 6.05 (dd, 1H, J = 2.3 Hz and 17.2 Hz, CH), 6.20 (dd, 1H, J = 10.1 Hz and 17.2 Hz, CH), 6.77 (t, 1H, J = 5.3 Hz, NH), 8.04 (bs, 1H, NH). Mass (electrospray+) calculated for C13H24N2O3 256, found 279 (256+Na+).
    Figure imgb0015
  • Product 2 (2.56g, 10 mmol) was dissolved in trifluoroacetic acid:dichloromethane (1:9, 100 ml) and stirred at room temperature. The progress of the reaction was monitored by TLC (dichloromethane : methanol 9:1). On completion, the reaction mixture was evaporated to dryness, the residue co-evaporated three times with toluene and then purified by flash chromatography (neat dichloromethane followed by a gradient of methanol up to 20%). Product 3 was obtained as a white powder (2.43 g, 9 mmol, 90%). 1H NMR (400 MHz, D2O): 1.29-1.40 (m, 2H, CH2), 1.52 (quint., 2H, J = 7.1 Hz, CH2), 1.61 (quint., 2H, J = 7.7 Hz, CH2), 2.92 (t, 2H, J = 7.6 Hz, CH2), 3.21 (t, 2H, J = 6.8 Hz, CH2), 5.68 (dd, 1H, J = 1.5 Hz and 10.1 Hz, CH), 6.10 (dd, 1H, J = 1.5 Hz and 17.2 Hz, CH), 6.20 (dd, 1H, J = 10.1 Hz and 17.2 Hz, CH). Mass (electrospray+) calculated for C8H16N20 156, found 179 (156+Na+).
  • To a suspension of product 3 (6.12 g, 22.64 mmol) and triethylamine (6.94 ml, 2.2 eq) in THF (120 ml) was added bromoacetyl chloride (2.07 ml, 1.1eq), through a pressure equalized dropping funnel, over a one hour period and at -60°C (cardice and isopropanol bath in a dewar). The reaction mixture was then stirred at room temperature overnight and the completion of the reaction was checked by TLC (dichloromethane : methanol 9:1) the following day. The salts formed during the reaction were filtered off and the reaction mixture evaporated to dryness. The residue was purified by chromatography (neat dichloromethane followed by a gradient of methanol up to 5%). 3.2 g (11.55 mmol, 51 %) of the product 1 (BRAPA) were obtained as a white powder. A further recrystallization performed in petroleum ether:ethyl acetate gave 3g of the product 1. 1H NMR (400 MHz, d6-DMSO) : 1.21-1.30 (m, 2H, CH2), 1.34-1.48 (m, 4H, 2xCH2), 3.02-3.12 (m, 4H, 2×CH2), 3.81 (s, 2H, CH2), 5.56 (d, 1H, J = 9.85 Hz, CH), 6.07 (d, 1H, J = 16.9 Hz, CH), 6.20 (dd, 1H, J = 10.1 Hz and 16.9 Hz, CH), 8.07 (bs, 1H, NH), 8.27 (bs, 1H, NH). Mass (electrospray+) calculated for C10H17BrN2O2 276 or 278, found 279 (278+H+), 299 (276+Na+).
  • The Cluster Formation Process Fluidics
  • For all fluidic steps during the cluster formation process, a peristaltic pump Ismatec IPC equipped with tubing Ismatec Ref 070534-051 (orange/yellow, 0.51 mm internal diameter) is optionally used. The pump is run in the forward direction (pulling fluids). A waste dish is installed to collect used solution at the outlet of the peristaltic pump tubing. During each step of the process, the different solutions used are dispensed into 8 tube microtube strips, using 1 tube per chip inlet tubing, in order to monitor the correct pumping of the solutions in each channel. The volume required per channel is specified for each step.
  • Thermal control
  • To enable incubation at different temperatures during the cluster formation process, the Silex chip is mounted on top of an MJ-Research thermocycler. The chip sits on top of a custom made copper block, which is attached to the flat heating block of the thermocycler. The chip is covered with a small Perspex block and is held in place by adhesive tape. Both pump and thermocycler are controlled by computer run scripts, which prompt the user to change solutions between each step.
  • Grafting primers onto surface of SFA coated chip
  • An SFA coated chip is placed onto a modified MJ-Research thermocycler and attached to a peristaltic pump as described above. Grafting mix consisting of 0.5 µM of a forward primer and 0.5 µM of a reverse primer in 10 mM phosphate buffer (pH 7.0) is pumped into the channels of the chip at a flow rate of 60 µl/min for 75 s at 20 °C. The thermocycler is then heated up to 51.6 °C, and the chip is incubated at this temperature for 1 hour. During this time, the grafting mix undergoes 18 cycles of pumping: grafting mix is pumped in at 15 µl/min for 20 s, then the solution is pumped back and forth (5 s forward at 15 µl/min, then 5 s backward at 15 µl/min) for 180 s. After 18 cycles of pumping, the chip is washed by pumping in 5xSSC/5mM EDTA at 15 µl/min for 300 s at 51.6 °C. The thermocycler is then cooled to 20 °C.
  • Template DNA Hybridization
  • The DNA templates to be hybridized to the grafted chip are diluted to the required concentration (currently 0.5-2pM) in 5×SSC/0.1% Tween. The diluted DNA is heated on a heating block at 100 °C for 5 min to denature the double stranded DNA into single strands suitable for hybridization. The DNA is then immediately snap-chilled in an ice/water bath for 3 min. The tubes containing the DNA are briefly spun in a centrifuge to collect any condensation, and then transferred to a pre-chilled 8-tube strip and used immediately.
  • The grafted chip from above is primed by pumping in 5×SSC/0.1% Tween at 60 µl/min for 75 s at 20 °C. The thermocycler is then heated to 98.5 °C, and the denatured DNA is pumped in at 15 µl/min for 300 s. An additional pump at 100 µl/min for 10 s is carried out to flush through bubbles formed by the heating of the hybridization mix. The temperature is then held at 98.5 °C for 30 s, before being cooled slowly to 40.2 °C over 19.5 min. The chip is then washed by pumping in 0.3×SSC/0.1% Tween at 15 µl/min for 300 s at 40.2 °C. The script then runs straight to the next step.
  • Amplification
  • The hybridized template molecules are amplified by a bridging polymerase chain reaction using the grafted primers and a thermostable polymerase. Amplification buffer consisting of 10 mM Tris (pH 9.0), 50 mM KCI, 1.5 mM MgC12, 1 M betaine and 1.3% DMSO is pumped into the chip at 15 p,l/min for 200 s at 40.2 °C. Then amplification mix of the above buffer supplemented with 200 µM dNTPs and 25 U/ml Taq polymerase is pumped in at 60 µl/min for 75 s at 40.2 °C. The thermocycler is then heated to 74 °C and held at this temperature for 90 s. This step enables extension of the surface bound primers to which the DNA template strands are hybridized. The thermocycler then carries out 50 cycles of amplification by heating to 98.5 °C for 45 s (denaturation of bridged strands), 58 °C for 90 s (annealing of strands to surface primers) and 74 °C for 90 s (primer extension). At the end of each incubation at 98.5 °C, fresh PCR mix is pumped into the channels of the chip at 15 µl/min for 10 s. As well as providing fresh reagents for each cycle of the PCR, this step also removes DNA strands and primers which have become detached from the surface and which could lead to contamination between clusters. At the end of thermocycling, the chip is cooled to 20 °C. The chip is then washed by pumping in 0.3×SSC/0.1% Tween at 15 µl/min for 300 s at 74 °C. The thermocycler is then cooled to 20 °C.
  • Linearization
  • Linearization mix consisting of 0.1 M sodium periodate and 0.1 M ethanolamine is pumped into the chip at 15 µl/min for 1 hr at 20 °C. The chip is then washed by pumping in water at 15 µl/min for 300 s at 20 °C.
  • Blocking (optional)
  • This step uses Terminal Transferase to incorporate a dideoxynucleotide onto the free 3' OH ends of DNA strands (both grafted primers and amplified cluster molecules).
  • Blocking buffer consisting of 50 mM potassium acetate, 20 mM Tris-acetate, 10 mM magnesium acetate, 1 mM dithiothreitol (pH 7.9) and 250µM CoCl2 is pumped into the chip at 15 µl/min for 200 s at 20 °C. Then Blocking Mix of the above buffer supplemented with 2.4 µM ddNTPs and 250 U/ml Terminal transferase is pumped in at 15 µl/min for 300 s at 37.7 °C. The thermocycler is held at 37.7 °C for 30 min, during which time Blocking Mix is pumped into the chip at 15 µl/min for 20 s every 3 min. After blocking, the chip is then washed by pumping in 0.3×SSC/0.1% Tween at 15 µl/min for 300 s at 20 °C.
  • Denaturation of clusters and hybridization of sequencing primer
  • This step uses NaOH to denature and wash away one of the strands of the amplified, linearized and blocked clusters. After a wash to remove the NaOH, the sequencing primer is then hybridized onto the single strands left on the surface.
  • After blocking, the double stranded DNA in the clusters is denatured by pumping in 0.1N NaOH at 15 µl/min for 300 s at 20 °C. The chip is then washed by pumping in TE (10 mM Tris pH 8.0, 1 mM EDTA) at 15 µl/min for 300 s at 20 °C. Sequencing primer is diluted to 0.5 µM in 5×SSC/0.1% Tween, and pumped into the channels at 15 µl/min for 300 s at 20 °C. The thermocycler is then heated up to 60 °C and held at this temperature for 15 min. The thermocycler is then cooled to 40.2 °C and the chip is washed by pumping in 0.3xSSC/0.1% Tween at 15 µl/min for 300 s.
  • The clusters are now ready for 1st cycle sequencing enzymology, e.g., with the systems and devices of the current invention.
  • The DNA sequence used in this process was a single monotemplate sequence of 400 bases, with ends complimentary to the grafted primers. The duplex DNA was denatured as described above.
  • Grafting of primers
  • The primers are typically 5'-phosphorothioate oligonucleotides incorporating any specific sequences or modifications required for cleavage. Their sequences and suppliers vary according to the experiment they are to be used for, and in this case were complementary to the 5'-ends of the template duplex.
  • Sequencing of linearized clusters
  • The amplified clusters contained a diol linkage in one of the grafted primers. Diol linkages can be introduced by including a suitable linkage into one of the primers used for solid-phase amplification.
  • Suitable primers including any desired template-specific sequence can be manufactured by standard automated DNA synthesis techniques using components available from commercial suppliers (e.g. Fidelity Systems Inc., ATD).
  • A cleavable diol-containing primer would typically have the following structure:
    5' -phosphorothioate-arm 26-diol22A-sequence-3' OH.
    Wherein "sequence" represents a sequence of nucleotides capable of hybridizing to the template to be amplified.
  • The structures of the arm26 and diol22A components (from Fidelity Systems Inc, MD, USA) are as follows:
    Figure imgb0016
    Products containing such diol linkages can be cleaved using periodate as described above, and the resulting single stranded polynucleotides hybridized as described above.
  • DNA sequencing cycles
  • Sequencing was carried out using modified nucleotides prepared as described in International patent application WO 2004/018493 , and labeled with four different commercially available fluorophores (Molecular Probes Inc.).
  • A mutant 9°N polymerase enzyme (an exo- variant including the triple mutation L408Y/Y409A/P410V and C223S) was used for the nucleotide incorporation steps.
  • Incorporation mix, Incorporation buffer (50 mM Tris-HCl pH 8.0, 6 mM MgSO4, 1 mM EDTA, 0.05% (v/v) Tween -20, 50mM NaCl) plus 110nM YAV exo-C223S, and 1µM each of the four labeled modified nucleotides, was applied to the clustered templates, and heated to 45°C.
  • Templates were maintained at 45°C for 30min, cooled to 20°C and washed with Incorporation buffer, then with 5x SSC/0.05% Tween 20. Templates were then exposed to Imaging buffer(100mM Tris pH7.0, 30mM NaCl, 0.05% Tween 20, 50mM sodium ascorbate, freshly dissolved).
  • Templates were scanned in 4 colors at RT.
  • Templates were then exposed to sequencing cycles of Cleavage and Incorporation as follows:
  • Cleavage
    • Prime with Cleavage buffer (0.1M Tris pH 7.4, 0.1M NaCl and 0.05% Tween 20). Heat to 60 °C.
    • Treat the clusters with Cleavage mix (100 mM TCEP in Cleavage buffer).
    • Wait for a total of 15 min in addition to pumping fresh buffer every 4 min.
    • Cool to 20 °C.
    • Wash with Enzymology buffer.
    • Wash with 5XSSC/0.05% Tween 20.
    • Prime with Imaging buffer.
    • Scan in 4 colors at RT.
    Incorporation Prime with Incorporation buffer Heat to 60 °C
    • Treat with Incorporation mix. Wait for a total of 15min in addition to pumping fresh Incorporation mix every 4 min.
    • Cool to 20 °C.
    • Wash with Incorporation buffer.
    • Wash with 5XSSC/0.05% Tween 20.
    • Prime with imaging buffer.
    • Scan in 4 colors at RT.
    • Repeat the process of Incorporation and Cleavage for as many cycles as required.
    • Incorporated nucleotides were detected using the fluorescent imaging apparatus described above.
  • Alternatively, the flowcell can be sequenced in a fully automated way, with the first incorporation being performed on this instrument, as described below:
  • After setting the flowcell on the instrument manifold, the templates can be exposed to the sequencing cycles described below : first base incorporation, imaging then alternating cleavage, imaging and incorporation, imaging steps for as many sequencing cycles as required.
  • First base incorporation
    • Pump 1000ul of incorporation buffer at RT
    • Set temperature at 55°C and hold
    • Wait for 2 minutes
    • Pump 600ul of incorporation mix
    • Wait for 4 minutes
    • Pump 200ul of incorporation mix
    • Wait for 4 minutes
    • Pump 200ul of incorporation mix
    • Wait for 4 minutes
    Set temperature at 22°C
    • Wait for 2 minutes
    • Pump 600ul of incorporation buffer
    • Pump 600ul of high salt buffer
    • Pump 800ul of scanning mix
    • Stop active cooling
    Imaging step Cleavage
    • Pump 1000ul of cleavage buffer at RT
    • Set temperature at 55°C and hold
    • Wait for 2 minutes
    • Pump 600ul of cleavage mix
    • Wait for 4 minutes
    • Pump 200ul of cleavage mix
    • Wait for 4 minutes
    • Pump 200ul of cleavage mix
    • Wait for 4 minutes
    • Set temperature at 22°C and hold
    • Wait for 2 minutes
    • Pump 600ul of incorporation buffer
    • Pump 600ul of high salt buffer
    • Pump 800ul of scanning mix
    • Stop active cooling
    Imaging step Incorporation
    • Pump 1000ul of incorporation buffer at RT
    • Set temperature at 55°C and hold
    • Wait for 2 minutes
    • Pump 600ul of incorporation mix
    • Wait for 4 minutes
    • Pump 200ul of incorporation mix
    • Wait for 4 minutes
    • Pump 200ul of incorporation mix
    • Wait for 4 minutes
    • Set temperature at 22°C and hold
    • Wait for 2 minutes
    • Pump 600ul of incorporation buffer
    • Pump 600ul of high salt buffer
    • Pump 800ul of scanning mix
    • Stop active cooling.
  • Each tile of each the chip for the non-fully automated process above was recorded in each of the four colors corresponding to the labeled nucleotides. The images were analyzed to pick the brightest color for each cluster, and this image intensity analysis was used to call the base for each cluster at each cycle. Images from each cycle were co-localized to obtain the sequence corresponding to each cluster. As the sequence of each cluster was known; and was the same for every cluster in the above experiment, the error rates (i.e. clusters not called as the correct sequence) could be analyzed for each cycle of nucleotide incorporation. The error rates were less than 1% for the first 20 cycles of the experiment, meaning the known sequence of the monotemplate was correctly called.
  • While the foregoing invention has been described in some detail for purposes of clarity and understanding, it will be clear to one skilled in the art from a reading of this disclosure that various changes in form and detail can be made without departing from the true scope of the invention. For example, all the techniques and apparatus described above may be used in various combinations. All publications, patents, patent applications, or other documents cited in this application are incorporated by reference in their entirety for all purposes to the same extent as if each individual publication, patent, patent application, or other document were individually indicated to be incorporated by reference for all purposes.
  • Further aspects of the invention are described in the following lettered paragraphs:
    1. A. A system for sequencing one or more polynucleotide, the system comprising:
      1. a) a solid substrate comprising one or more polynucleotides attached thereto;
      2. b) a fluid direction system for controllably moving one or more fluorescently labeled reagents into contact with the polynucleotides;
      3. c) a temperature control system for regulating the temperature of the substrate and/or of the reagents;
      4. d) an illumination system for exciting the fluorescent moiety via total internal reflection (TIR);
      5. e) a detector component proximal to the substrate for detecting fluorescence produced from excitation of the moiety by the TIR system;
      6. f) a computer system operably coupled to the detector wherein the computer comprises an instruction set for acquiring fluorescence images from the detector.
    2. B. The system of lettered paragraph A, wherein the substrate can be moved distal to the detector in order for the temperature control system to regulate the temperature of the substrate.
    3. C. The system of lettered paragraph A, wherein the solid substrate comprises a flowcell, which flowcell comprises one or more fluidic channel in which the polynucleotide is attached.
    4. D. The system of lettered paragraph A, wherein the substrate comprises glass, silicon, or plastic.
    5. E. The system according to lettered paragraph A, wherein said solid substrate is an array of beads.
    6. F. The system of lettered paragraph A, wherein the reagents comprise components to extend a second sequence complementary to the one or more polynucleotides.
    7. G. The system according to lettered paragraph F, wherein said reagents are fluorescently labeled nucleoside triphosphates
    8. H. The system according to lettered paragraph F, wherein said reagents are fluorescently labeled oligonucleotides.
    9. I. The system of lettered paragraph A, wherein the illumination system comprises at least one excitation laser coupled through a fiberoptic device.
    10. J. The system according to lettered paragraph I, wherein said fiber is physically deformed to obtain a uniform illumination footprint.
    11. K. The system according to lettered paragraph J, wherein said physical deformation is squeezing.
    12. L. The system according to lettered paragraph J, wherein said physical deformation is vibrating.
    13. M. The system of lettered paragraph A, wherein the detector comprises a CCD camera.
    14. N. The system of lettered paragraph A, wherein said detector comprises two CCD cameras.
    15. O. The system of lettered paragraph A, wherein said detector comprises four CCD cameras.
    16. P. The system of lettered paragraph A, wherein the detector further comprises one or more optic filters appropriate to the fluorescence emission of the fluorescently labeled reagent and to one or more wavelength of light from the laser.
    17. Q. The system of lettered paragraph A, when the detector component comprises an autofocus mechanism.
    18. R. The system of lettered paragraph A comprising two fluidics stations for operating on two flowcells simultaneously.
    19. S. The system of lettered paragraph A, wherein the illumination system comprises two excitation lasers coupled through a fiberoptic device, wherein such lasers illuminate at least part of the same area.
    20. T. The system of lettered paragraph P, wherein the detector further comprises four optic filters appropriate to the fluorescence emission of the four fluorescently labeled reagents and to the wavelength of light from the lasers.
    21. U. The system of lettered paragraph S, wherein said lasers emit at a wavelength of 532 nm and 660 nm.

Claims (15)

  1. A system configured for sequencing one or more polynucleotides, the system comprising:
    a) a dual flowcell holder configured to hold two flowcells, each of the flowcells having one or more channels having one or more polynucleotides attached in the one or more channels;
    b) a fluidics system for controllably moving one or more reagents having fluorescent labels into contact with the polynucleotides;
    c) a temperature control system for regulating a temperature of the two flowcells or of the reagents;
    d) an illumination system for exciting the fluorescent labels;
    e) an objective lens configured to be proximal to the flowcells for detecting fluorescence produced from excitation of the fluorescent labels by the illumination system;
    f) a computer system operably coupled to the objective lens wherein the computer system comprises an instruction set for acquiring fluorescence images from the objective lens and determining a polynucleotide sequence from the detected fluorescence.
  2. The system of claim 1, wherein the reagents comprise components to extend a second sequence complementary to the one or more polynucleotides.
  3. The system according to claim 2, wherein said reagents are fluorescently labeled nucleoside triphosphates.
  4. The system according to claim 2, wherein said reagents are fluorescently labeled oligonucleotides.
  5. The system of claim 1, wherein the illumination system comprises at least one excitation laser coupled through a fiberoptic device.
  6. The system of claim 1, wherein the fluidics system comprises two fluidics stations for operating on two flowcells simultaneously.
  7. The system of claim 1, wherein the illumination system comprises two excitation lasers coupled through a fiberoptic device.
  8. The system of claim 1, wherein the reagents include four different nucleotides having respective fluorescent labels.
  9. The system of claim 1, wherein the two flowcells are held down by vacuum.
  10. The system of claim 1, wherein the fluidics system moves the one or more reagents to enter the top side of the two flowcells.
  11. The system of claim 1, wherein the fluidics system moves the one or more reagents to enter the bottom side of the two flowcells.
  12. The system of claim 1, wherein the illumination system moves vertically in relation to the two flowcells.
  13. The system of claim 1, wherein the objective lens moves vertically in relation to the two flowcells.
  14. The system of claim 13, further comprising an autofocus laser beam directed to the two flowcells to reflect the autofocus beam from surfaces of the two flowcells.
  15. The system of claim 14, wherein the reflected autofocus beam is a focusing camera or an imaging camera.
EP22177074.6A 2006-03-31 2007-03-30 Systems and devices for sequence by synthesis analysis Pending EP4105644A3 (en)

Applications Claiming Priority (6)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US78824806P 2006-03-31 2006-03-31
US79536806P 2006-04-26 2006-04-26
EP20158102.2A EP3722409A1 (en) 2006-03-31 2007-03-30 Systems and devices for sequence by synthesis analysis
PCT/US2007/007991 WO2007123744A2 (en) 2006-03-31 2007-03-30 Systems and devices for sequence by synthesis analysis
EP07754505.1A EP2018622B1 (en) 2006-03-31 2007-03-30 Systems for sequence by synthesis analysis
EP18168962.1A EP3373174A1 (en) 2006-03-31 2007-03-30 Systems and devices for sequence by synthesis analysis

Related Parent Applications (3)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
EP18168962.1A Division EP3373174A1 (en) 2006-03-31 2007-03-30 Systems and devices for sequence by synthesis analysis
EP07754505.1A Division EP2018622B1 (en) 2006-03-31 2007-03-30 Systems for sequence by synthesis analysis
EP20158102.2A Division EP3722409A1 (en) 2006-03-31 2007-03-30 Systems and devices for sequence by synthesis analysis

Publications (2)

Publication Number Publication Date
EP4105644A2 true EP4105644A2 (en) 2022-12-21
EP4105644A3 EP4105644A3 (en) 2022-12-28

Family

ID=38625484

Family Applications (4)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
EP18168962.1A Withdrawn EP3373174A1 (en) 2006-03-31 2007-03-30 Systems and devices for sequence by synthesis analysis
EP07754505.1A Active EP2018622B1 (en) 2006-03-31 2007-03-30 Systems for sequence by synthesis analysis
EP22177074.6A Pending EP4105644A3 (en) 2006-03-31 2007-03-30 Systems and devices for sequence by synthesis analysis
EP20158102.2A Ceased EP3722409A1 (en) 2006-03-31 2007-03-30 Systems and devices for sequence by synthesis analysis

Family Applications Before (2)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
EP18168962.1A Withdrawn EP3373174A1 (en) 2006-03-31 2007-03-30 Systems and devices for sequence by synthesis analysis
EP07754505.1A Active EP2018622B1 (en) 2006-03-31 2007-03-30 Systems for sequence by synthesis analysis

Family Applications After (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
EP20158102.2A Ceased EP3722409A1 (en) 2006-03-31 2007-03-30 Systems and devices for sequence by synthesis analysis

Country Status (8)

Country Link
US (1) US8241573B2 (en)
EP (4) EP3373174A1 (en)
JP (1) JP5122555B2 (en)
CN (1) CN101460953B (en)
CA (1) CA2648149A1 (en)
ES (1) ES2675047T3 (en)
SG (1) SG170802A1 (en)
WO (1) WO2007123744A2 (en)

Families Citing this family (679)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO2004083443A1 (en) * 2002-12-20 2004-09-30 Caliper Life Sciences, Inc. Single molecule amplification and detection of dna
GB0307403D0 (en) 2003-03-31 2003-05-07 Medical Res Council Selection by compartmentalised screening
US20060078893A1 (en) 2004-10-12 2006-04-13 Medical Research Council Compartmentalised combinatorial chemistry by microfluidic control
GB0307428D0 (en) 2003-03-31 2003-05-07 Medical Res Council Compartmentalised combinatorial chemistry
US20050221339A1 (en) 2004-03-31 2005-10-06 Medical Research Council Harvard University Compartmentalised screening by microfluidic control
US7968287B2 (en) 2004-10-08 2011-06-28 Medical Research Council Harvard University In vitro evolution in microfluidic systems
EP3913375A1 (en) 2006-01-11 2021-11-24 Bio-Rad Laboratories, Inc. Microfluidic devices and methods of use in the formation and control of nanoreactors
US9562837B2 (en) 2006-05-11 2017-02-07 Raindance Technologies, Inc. Systems for handling microfludic droplets
WO2007133710A2 (en) 2006-05-11 2007-11-22 Raindance Technologies, Inc. Microfluidic devices and methods of use thereof
US8921073B2 (en) 2006-06-23 2014-12-30 Illumina, Inc. Devices and systems for creation of DNA cluster arrays
EP3536396B1 (en) 2006-08-07 2022-03-30 The President and Fellows of Harvard College Fluorocarbon emulsion stabilizing surfactants
EP2126766A2 (en) 2007-01-26 2009-12-02 Illumina Inc. Image data efficient genetic sequencing method and system
US8315817B2 (en) 2007-01-26 2012-11-20 Illumina, Inc. Independently removable nucleic acid sequencing system and method
US11940413B2 (en) * 2007-02-05 2024-03-26 IsoPlexis Corporation Methods and devices for sequencing nucleic acids in smaller batches
WO2008097559A2 (en) 2007-02-06 2008-08-14 Brandeis University Manipulation of fluids and reactions in microfluidic systems
JP4843543B2 (en) * 2007-03-28 2011-12-21 株式会社日立ハイテクノロジーズ Fluorescence detection apparatus and method
US8592221B2 (en) 2007-04-19 2013-11-26 Brandeis University Manipulation of fluids, fluid components and reactions in microfluidic systems
WO2009042862A1 (en) 2007-09-28 2009-04-02 Illumina, Inc Fluorescence excitation and detection system and method
PT2209893E (en) 2007-10-12 2014-02-26 Pronota Nv Use of aptamers in proteomics
US8617811B2 (en) 2008-01-28 2013-12-31 Complete Genomics, Inc. Methods and compositions for efficient base calling in sequencing reactions
US20170022558A1 (en) * 2007-10-30 2017-01-26 Complete Genomics, Inc. Integrated system for nucleic acid sequence and analysis
US20230200031A1 (en) 2007-11-16 2023-06-22 Manufacturing Resources International, Inc. Electronic display assembly with thermal management
US8854595B2 (en) 2008-03-03 2014-10-07 Manufacturing Resources International, Inc. Constricted convection cooling system for an electronic display
US8263367B2 (en) 2008-01-25 2012-09-11 Agency For Science, Technology And Research Nucleic acid interaction analysis
US8173080B2 (en) 2008-02-14 2012-05-08 Illumina, Inc. Flow cells and manifolds having an electroosmotic pump
US8497972B2 (en) * 2009-11-13 2013-07-30 Manufacturing Resources International, Inc. Thermal plate with optional cooling loop in electronic display
US8773633B2 (en) 2008-03-03 2014-07-08 Manufacturing Resources International, Inc. Expanded heat sink for electronic displays
US9173325B2 (en) 2008-03-26 2015-10-27 Manufacturing Resources International, Inc. Heat exchanger for back to back electronic displays
US8654302B2 (en) 2008-03-03 2014-02-18 Manufacturing Resources International, Inc. Heat exchanger for an electronic display
US8367976B2 (en) * 2008-03-21 2013-02-05 Lawrence Livermore National Security, Llc Laser heating of aqueous samples on a micro-optical-electro-mechanical system
US8693185B2 (en) 2008-03-26 2014-04-08 Manufacturing Resources International, Inc. System and method for maintaining a consistent temperature gradient across an electronic display
JP5072688B2 (en) 2008-04-02 2012-11-14 キヤノン株式会社 Scanning imaging device
US7903706B2 (en) * 2008-04-04 2011-03-08 O'shaughnessy John Compact, thermally stable multi-laser engine
US9413130B2 (en) 2012-12-12 2016-08-09 Cvi Laser, Llc Optical systems
US10114213B2 (en) 2008-04-04 2018-10-30 Cvi Laser, Llc Laser systems and optical devices for manipulating laser beams
US8975572B2 (en) * 2008-04-04 2015-03-10 Cvi Laser, Llc Compact, thermally stable fiber-optic array mountable to flow cell
US8039817B2 (en) 2008-05-05 2011-10-18 Illumina, Inc. Compensator for multiple surface imaging
JP2011523466A (en) * 2008-05-06 2011-08-11 ヒューレット−パッカード デベロップメント カンパニー エル.ピー. Fabrication of thin pellicle beam splitter
WO2010003132A1 (en) 2008-07-02 2010-01-07 Illumina Cambridge Ltd. Using populations of beads for the fabrication of arrays on surfaces
WO2010009365A1 (en) 2008-07-18 2010-01-21 Raindance Technologies, Inc. Droplet libraries
US12038438B2 (en) 2008-07-18 2024-07-16 Bio-Rad Laboratories, Inc. Enzyme quantification
JP2010022315A (en) * 2008-07-23 2010-02-04 Sony Corp Nucleic acid quantity detection device and nucleic acid quantity detection method
US8736751B2 (en) * 2008-08-26 2014-05-27 Empire Technology Development Llc Digital presenter for displaying image captured by camera with illumination system
US8383345B2 (en) 2008-09-12 2013-02-26 University Of Washington Sequence tag directed subassembly of short sequencing reads into long sequencing reads
WO2010038042A1 (en) 2008-10-02 2010-04-08 Illumina Cambridge Ltd. Nucleic acid sample enrichment for sequencing applications
WO2010048337A2 (en) 2008-10-22 2010-04-29 Illumina, Inc. Preservation of information related to genomic dna methylation
WO2010062775A2 (en) 2008-11-03 2010-06-03 The Regents Of The University Of California Methods for detecting modification resistant nucleic acids
CA2881741C (en) 2008-11-26 2018-04-03 Illumina, Inc Electroosmotic pump with improved gas management
US20100157086A1 (en) 2008-12-15 2010-06-24 Illumina, Inc Dynamic autofocus method and system for assay imager
US10827656B2 (en) 2008-12-18 2020-11-03 Manufacturing Resources International, Inc. System for cooling an electronic image assembly with circulating gas and ambient gas
US8749749B2 (en) 2008-12-18 2014-06-10 Manufacturing Resources International, Inc. System for cooling an electronic image assembly with manifolds and ambient gas
US8236532B2 (en) 2008-12-23 2012-08-07 Illumina, Inc. Multibase delivery for long reads in sequencing by synthesis protocols
EP2411148B1 (en) 2009-03-23 2018-02-21 Raindance Technologies, Inc. Manipulation of microfluidic droplets
EP2425240A4 (en) 2009-04-30 2012-12-12 Good Start Genetics Inc Methods and compositions for evaluating genetic markers
US12129514B2 (en) 2009-04-30 2024-10-29 Molecular Loop Biosolutions, Llc Methods and compositions for evaluating genetic markers
US20100279882A1 (en) * 2009-05-01 2010-11-04 Mostafa Ronaghi Sequencing methods
US20120064527A1 (en) * 2009-05-27 2012-03-15 Akira Maekawa Nucleic acid analysis device, nucleic acid analysis apparatus, and nucleic acid analysis method
EP2437887B1 (en) 2009-06-04 2016-05-11 Lockheed Martin Corporation Multiple-sample microfluidic chip for dna analysis
WO2011011175A2 (en) 2009-07-24 2011-01-27 Illumina, Inc. Method for sequencing a polynucleotide template
DK2669387T3 (en) 2009-08-25 2016-09-19 Illumina Inc Methods of selection and amplification of polynucleotides
US8182994B2 (en) * 2009-09-15 2012-05-22 Illumina Cambridge Limited Centroid markers for image analysis of high denisty clusters in complex polynucleotide sequencing
WO2011042564A1 (en) 2009-10-09 2011-04-14 Universite De Strasbourg Labelled silica-based nanomaterial with enhanced properties and uses thereof
US10837883B2 (en) 2009-12-23 2020-11-17 Bio-Rad Laboratories, Inc. Microfluidic systems and methods for reducing the exchange of molecules between droplets
EP3151052A1 (en) 2010-02-01 2017-04-05 Illumina, Inc. Focusing methods and optical systems and assemblies using the same
US10351905B2 (en) 2010-02-12 2019-07-16 Bio-Rad Laboratories, Inc. Digital analyte analysis
WO2011100604A2 (en) 2010-02-12 2011-08-18 Raindance Technologies, Inc. Digital analyte analysis
US9366632B2 (en) 2010-02-12 2016-06-14 Raindance Technologies, Inc. Digital analyte analysis
US9399797B2 (en) 2010-02-12 2016-07-26 Raindance Technologies, Inc. Digital analyte analysis
WO2011103467A2 (en) 2010-02-19 2011-08-25 Life Technologies Corporation Methods and systems for nucleic acid sequencing validation, calibration and normalization
DE202011003570U1 (en) 2010-03-06 2012-01-30 Illumina, Inc. Systems and apparatus for detecting optical signals from a sample
US10787701B2 (en) 2010-04-05 2020-09-29 Prognosys Biosciences, Inc. Spatially encoded biological assays
CN102834526B (en) 2010-04-05 2015-12-02 普罗格诺西斯生物科学公司 The biological characteristis of spatial encoding
US20190300945A1 (en) 2010-04-05 2019-10-03 Prognosys Biosciences, Inc. Spatially Encoded Biological Assays
US9353412B2 (en) 2010-06-18 2016-05-31 Illumina, Inc. Conformational probes and methods for sequencing nucleic acids
US8465922B2 (en) * 2010-08-26 2013-06-18 Pacific Biosciences Of California, Inc. Methods and systems for monitoring reactions
US9029103B2 (en) 2010-08-27 2015-05-12 Illumina Cambridge Limited Methods for sequencing polynucleotides
WO2012050920A1 (en) * 2010-09-29 2012-04-19 Illumina, Inc. Compositions and methods for sequencing nucleic acids
EP2622103B2 (en) 2010-09-30 2022-11-16 Bio-Rad Laboratories, Inc. Sandwich assays in droplets
CA2814720C (en) 2010-10-15 2016-12-13 Lockheed Martin Corporation Micro fluidic optic design
WO2012055929A1 (en) 2010-10-26 2012-05-03 Illumina, Inc. Sequencing methods
US8575071B2 (en) 2010-11-03 2013-11-05 Illumina, Inc. Reducing adapter dimer formation
US9074251B2 (en) 2011-02-10 2015-07-07 Illumina, Inc. Linking sequence reads using paired code tags
WO2012061832A1 (en) 2010-11-05 2012-05-10 Illumina, Inc. Linking sequence reads using paired code tags
WO2012074855A2 (en) 2010-11-22 2012-06-07 The Regents Of The University Of California Methods of identifying a cellular nascent rna transcript
US9163281B2 (en) 2010-12-23 2015-10-20 Good Start Genetics, Inc. Methods for maintaining the integrity and identification of a nucleic acid template in a multiplex sequencing reaction
US8951781B2 (en) 2011-01-10 2015-02-10 Illumina, Inc. Systems, methods, and apparatuses to image a sample for biological or chemical analysis
EP2670864B1 (en) 2011-01-31 2017-03-08 Illumina, Inc. Methods for reducing nucleic acid damage
JP6017458B2 (en) 2011-02-02 2016-11-02 ユニヴァーシティ・オブ・ワシントン・スルー・イッツ・センター・フォー・コマーシャリゼーション Mass parallel continuity mapping
EP3859011A1 (en) 2011-02-11 2021-08-04 Bio-Rad Laboratories, Inc. Methods for forming mixed droplets
WO2012112804A1 (en) 2011-02-18 2012-08-23 Raindance Technoligies, Inc. Compositions and methods for molecular labeling
CN102250751B (en) 2011-03-22 2013-05-22 博奥生物有限公司 Interface device for biochip
GB201106254D0 (en) 2011-04-13 2011-05-25 Frisen Jonas Method and product
WO2012159214A1 (en) * 2011-05-25 2012-11-29 Obzerv Technologies Inc. Active imaging device having field of view and field of illumination with corresponding rectangular aspect ratios
DE202012013668U1 (en) 2011-06-02 2019-04-18 Raindance Technologies, Inc. enzyme quantification
US8841071B2 (en) 2011-06-02 2014-09-23 Raindance Technologies, Inc. Sample multiplexing
EP2718465B1 (en) 2011-06-09 2022-04-13 Illumina, Inc. Method of making an analyte array
AU2012272161B2 (en) 2011-06-21 2015-12-24 Illumina Cambridge Limited Methods and systems for data analysis
US8658430B2 (en) 2011-07-20 2014-02-25 Raindance Technologies, Inc. Manipulating droplet size
US8889860B2 (en) * 2011-09-13 2014-11-18 Lasergen, Inc. 3′-OH unblocked, fast photocleavable terminating nucleotides and methods for nucleic acid sequencing
DK2768972T3 (en) 2011-09-23 2017-09-25 Illumina Inc Methods and Compositions for Nucleic Acid Sequencing
AU2012316218B2 (en) 2011-09-26 2016-03-17 Gen-Probe Incorporated Algorithms for sequence determinations
US10378051B2 (en) 2011-09-29 2019-08-13 Illumina Cambridge Limited Continuous extension and deblocking in reactions for nucleic acids synthesis and sequencing
EP3604555A1 (en) 2011-10-14 2020-02-05 President and Fellows of Harvard College Sequencing by structure assembly
WO2013058907A1 (en) 2011-10-17 2013-04-25 Good Start Genetics, Inc. Analysis methods
WO2013063382A2 (en) 2011-10-28 2013-05-02 Illumina, Inc. Microarray fabrication system and method
WO2013070627A2 (en) 2011-11-07 2013-05-16 Illumina, Inc. Integrated sequencing apparatuses and methods of use
US9200274B2 (en) 2011-12-09 2015-12-01 Illumina, Inc. Expanded radix for polymeric tags
US9279154B2 (en) 2011-12-21 2016-03-08 Illumina, Inc. Apparatus and methods for kinetic analysis and determination of nucleic acid sequences
WO2014163886A1 (en) 2013-03-12 2014-10-09 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Method of generating a three-dimensional nucleic acid containing matrix
US11021737B2 (en) 2011-12-22 2021-06-01 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Compositions and methods for analyte detection
EP4108782B1 (en) 2011-12-22 2023-06-07 President and Fellows of Harvard College Compositions and methods for analyte detection
WO2013117595A2 (en) 2012-02-07 2013-08-15 Illumina Cambridge Limited Targeted enrichment and amplification of nucleic acids on a support
EP2817418B1 (en) 2012-02-24 2017-10-11 Raindance Technologies, Inc. Labeling and sample preparation for sequencing
NO2694769T3 (en) 2012-03-06 2018-03-03
CN102591100B (en) * 2012-03-16 2015-09-02 盛司潼 Autofocus system and the method thereof of figure equipment are adopted in a kind of order-checking
US20130261984A1 (en) 2012-03-30 2013-10-03 Illumina, Inc. Methods and systems for determining fetal chromosomal abnormalities
ES2949570T3 (en) 2012-04-03 2023-09-29 Illumina Inc Integrated optoelectronic readout head and fluid cartridge useful for nucleic acid sequencing
US8209130B1 (en) 2012-04-04 2012-06-26 Good Start Genetics, Inc. Sequence assembly
US8812422B2 (en) 2012-04-09 2014-08-19 Good Start Genetics, Inc. Variant database
US9444880B2 (en) 2012-04-11 2016-09-13 Illumina, Inc. Cloud computing environment for biological data
US20130274148A1 (en) 2012-04-11 2013-10-17 Illumina, Inc. Portable genetic detection and analysis system and method
US10227635B2 (en) 2012-04-16 2019-03-12 Molecular Loop Biosolutions, Llc Capture reactions
CN102703310B (en) * 2012-05-24 2013-10-16 中国科学院北京基因组研究所 CCD (charge coupled device) camera directly coupled with sequencing chip
US20140163900A1 (en) * 2012-06-02 2014-06-12 Whitehead Institute For Biomedical Research Analyzing short tandem repeats from high throughput sequencing data for genetic applications
US9914967B2 (en) 2012-06-05 2018-03-13 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Spatial sequencing of nucleic acids using DNA origami probes
US9012022B2 (en) 2012-06-08 2015-04-21 Illumina, Inc. Polymer coatings
US8895249B2 (en) 2012-06-15 2014-11-25 Illumina, Inc. Kinetic exclusion amplification of nucleic acid libraries
CA2878291A1 (en) 2012-07-03 2014-01-09 Sloan Kettering Institute For Cancer Research Quantitative assessment of human t-cell repertoire recovery after allogeneic hematopoietic stem cell transplantation
US9092401B2 (en) 2012-10-31 2015-07-28 Counsyl, Inc. System and methods for detecting genetic variation
CN108456717A (en) 2012-07-17 2018-08-28 考希尔股份有限公司 The system and method for detecting hereditary variation
US9977861B2 (en) 2012-07-18 2018-05-22 Illumina Cambridge Limited Methods and systems for determining haplotypes and phasing of haplotypes
NL2017959B1 (en) 2016-12-08 2018-06-19 Illumina Inc Cartridge assembly
EP2885626B1 (en) 2012-08-20 2020-03-04 Illumina, Inc. An integrated detection, flow cell and photonics (dfp) device
WO2014034275A1 (en) * 2012-08-30 2014-03-06 株式会社 日立ハイテクノロジーズ Nucleic acid analysis device
WO2014062815A1 (en) 2012-10-16 2014-04-24 Manufacturing Resources International, Inc. Back pan cooling assembly for electric display
CA2886974C (en) 2012-10-17 2021-06-29 Spatial Transcriptomics Ab Methods and product for optimising localised or spatial detection of gene expression in a tissue sample
US9181583B2 (en) 2012-10-23 2015-11-10 Illumina, Inc. HLA typing using selective amplification and sequencing
US10942184B2 (en) 2012-10-23 2021-03-09 Caris Science, Inc. Aptamers and uses thereof
CA2928520C (en) 2012-10-23 2023-03-14 Caris Life Sciences Switzerland Holdings, S.A.R.L. Aptamers and uses thereof
WO2014100434A1 (en) 2012-12-19 2014-06-26 Caris Science, Inc. Compositions and methods for aptamer screening
US9683230B2 (en) 2013-01-09 2017-06-20 Illumina Cambridge Limited Sample preparation on a solid support
US9805407B2 (en) 2013-01-25 2017-10-31 Illumina, Inc. Methods and systems for using a cloud computing environment to configure and sell a biological sample preparation cartridge and share related data
US9512422B2 (en) 2013-02-26 2016-12-06 Illumina, Inc. Gel patterned surfaces
US9914979B2 (en) 2013-03-04 2018-03-13 Fry Laboratories, LLC Method and kit for characterizing microorganisms
EP3553175B1 (en) 2013-03-13 2021-07-14 Illumina, Inc. Method of preparing a nucleic acid sequencing library
WO2014143158A1 (en) 2013-03-13 2014-09-18 The Broad Institute, Inc. Compositions and methods for labeling of agents
US20160023208A1 (en) 2013-03-13 2016-01-28 Illumina, Inc. Multilayer fluidic devices and methods for their fabrication
US9146248B2 (en) 2013-03-14 2015-09-29 Intelligent Bio-Systems, Inc. Apparatus and methods for purging flow cells in nucleic acid sequencing instruments
AU2013382024B2 (en) 2013-03-14 2019-01-31 Illumina, Inc. Modified polymerases for improved incorporation of nucleotide analogues
EP2971159B1 (en) 2013-03-14 2019-05-08 Molecular Loop Biosolutions, LLC Methods for analyzing nucleic acids
EP2970356B1 (en) 2013-03-15 2018-05-30 Illumina Cambridge Limited Modified nucleosides or nucleotides
US20140274747A1 (en) 2013-03-15 2014-09-18 Illumina, Inc. Super resolution imaging
CN105143850B (en) 2013-03-15 2018-08-21 艾瑞思国际股份有限公司 Autofocus system and method for the particle analysis in blood sample
US10524384B2 (en) 2013-03-15 2019-12-31 Manufacturing Resources International, Inc. Cooling assembly for an electronic display
US9591268B2 (en) 2013-03-15 2017-03-07 Qiagen Waltham, Inc. Flow cell alignment methods and systems
EP2971071B1 (en) 2013-03-15 2018-02-28 Illumina, Inc. Enzyme-linked nucleotides
US9193998B2 (en) 2013-03-15 2015-11-24 Illumina, Inc. Super resolution imaging
US9648790B2 (en) 2013-03-15 2017-05-09 Manufacturing Resources International, Inc. Heat exchanger assembly for an electronic display
US8847799B1 (en) 2013-06-03 2014-09-30 Good Start Genetics, Inc. Methods and systems for storing sequence read data
KR20230042154A (en) 2013-06-04 2023-03-27 프레지던트 앤드 펠로우즈 오브 하바드 칼리지 Rna-guideded transcriptional regulation
EP3013984B1 (en) 2013-06-25 2023-03-22 Prognosys Biosciences, Inc. Methods for determining spatial patterns of biological targets in a sample
WO2015002813A1 (en) 2013-07-01 2015-01-08 Illumina, Inc. Catalyst-free surface functionalization and polymer grafting
ES2719579T3 (en) 2013-07-03 2019-07-11 Illumina Inc System for sequencing by orthogonal synthesis
US9470924B2 (en) 2013-07-08 2016-10-18 Manufacturing Resources International, Inc. Figure eight closed loop cooling system for electronic display
CN105555966B (en) * 2013-07-31 2020-09-25 株式会社日立高新技术 Flow cell for nucleic acid analysis and nucleic acid analysis device
EP3722442B1 (en) * 2013-08-05 2023-04-05 Twist Bioscience Corporation De novo synthesized gene libraries
CA3091557C (en) 2013-08-08 2022-10-18 Illumina, Inc. Fluidic system for reagent delivery to a flow cell
US9540690B2 (en) 2013-08-28 2017-01-10 Illumina, Inc. Optical alignment tool
AU2014312043A1 (en) 2013-08-30 2016-02-25 Illumina France Manipulation of droplets on hydrophilic or variegated-hydrophilic surfaces
US9352315B2 (en) 2013-09-27 2016-05-31 Taiwan Semiconductor Manufacturing Company, Ltd. Method to produce chemical pattern in micro-fluidic structure
US11901041B2 (en) 2013-10-04 2024-02-13 Bio-Rad Laboratories, Inc. Digital analysis of nucleic acid modification
US10851414B2 (en) 2013-10-18 2020-12-01 Good Start Genetics, Inc. Methods for determining carrier status
WO2015057565A1 (en) 2013-10-18 2015-04-23 Good Start Genetics, Inc. Methods for assessing a genomic region of a subject
EP3058550B1 (en) * 2013-10-18 2021-04-28 Koninklijke Philips N.V. Image based roi tracking for mdx
CN104570813A (en) * 2013-10-25 2015-04-29 仲兆准 Integrated controller for spray drying instrument
GB201318919D0 (en) * 2013-10-25 2013-12-11 Isis Innovation Compact microscope
EP3064928B1 (en) * 2013-10-31 2019-04-17 Konica Minolta, Inc. Detection device, detection method using said detection device
US10540783B2 (en) 2013-11-01 2020-01-21 Illumina, Inc. Image analysis useful for patterned objects
CN113390839A (en) 2013-11-29 2021-09-14 皇家飞利浦有限公司 Optical control of chemical reactions
RS60736B1 (en) 2013-12-03 2020-09-30 Illumina Inc Methods and systems for analyzing image data
AU2014364006B2 (en) 2013-12-10 2019-07-11 Illumina, Inc. Biosensors for biological or chemical analysis and methods of manufacturing the same
US9944977B2 (en) 2013-12-12 2018-04-17 Raindance Technologies, Inc. Distinguishing rare variations in a nucleic acid sequence from a sample
CA2928598C (en) 2013-12-19 2022-11-29 M. Shane Bowen Substrates comprising nano-patterning surfaces and methods of preparing thereof
DK3083994T3 (en) 2013-12-20 2021-09-13 Illumina Inc Preservation of genomic connectivity information in fragmented genomic DNA samples
JP7082860B2 (en) 2013-12-23 2022-06-09 イラミーナ インコーポレーテッド Methods for Structured and Structured Substrate to Improve Detection of Light Radiation
US11193176B2 (en) 2013-12-31 2021-12-07 Bio-Rad Laboratories, Inc. Method for detecting and quantifying latent retroviral RNA species
US10537889B2 (en) 2013-12-31 2020-01-21 Illumina, Inc. Addressable flow cell using patterned electrodes
WO2015105993A1 (en) 2014-01-09 2015-07-16 AgBiome, Inc. High throughput discovery of new genes from complex mixtures of environmental microbes
BR112016016546B1 (en) 2014-01-16 2022-09-06 Illumina, Inc AMPLICON PREPARATION METHOD AND METHODS FOR DETERMINING THE PRESENCE OF A CANCER-ASSOCIATED GENE AND A TRUE NUCLEIC ACID SEQUENCE VARIANT
US9677132B2 (en) 2014-01-16 2017-06-13 Illumina, Inc. Polynucleotide modification on solid support
JP6430703B2 (en) * 2014-01-31 2018-11-28 三菱電線工業株式会社 Optical fiber device
BR112016019267B8 (en) 2014-02-18 2023-01-10 Illumina Inc METHOD TO BUILD A DNA PROFILE, NUCLEIC ACID LIBRARY, METHOD TO BUILD A NUCLEIC ACID LIBRARY, PLURALITY OF PRIMERS AND KIT
EP3117693B1 (en) 2014-03-11 2019-08-07 Manufacturing Resources International, Inc. Hybrid rear cover and mounting bracket for eletronic display
US10767219B2 (en) 2014-03-11 2020-09-08 Illumina, Inc. Disposable, integrated microfluidic cartridge and methods of making and using same
CA3060708A1 (en) 2014-04-29 2015-11-05 Illumina, Inc Multiplexed single cell gene expression analysis using template switch and tagmentation
KR101885884B1 (en) 2014-04-30 2018-08-07 매뉴팩처링 리소시스 인터내셔널 인코포레이티드 Back to back electronic display assembly
EP3140428B1 (en) * 2014-05-08 2021-07-28 Fluidigm Corporation Method of tagging nucleic acid sequences
US11053548B2 (en) 2014-05-12 2021-07-06 Good Start Genetics, Inc. Methods for detecting aneuploidy
CN106536734B (en) 2014-05-16 2020-12-22 Illumina公司 Nucleic acid synthesis technology
RU2682546C2 (en) 2014-05-27 2019-03-19 Иллумина, Инк. Systems and methods of biochemical analysis including main device and removable cartridge
GB201409777D0 (en) 2014-06-02 2014-07-16 Illumina Cambridge Ltd Methods of reducing density-dependent GC bias in isothermal amplification
CN113584139B (en) 2014-06-03 2024-08-13 亿明达股份有限公司 Compositions, systems and methods for detecting events using tethers anchored to or near nanoparticles
US20150353989A1 (en) 2014-06-09 2015-12-10 Illumina Cambridge Limited Sample preparation for nucleic acid amplification
EP3155125A1 (en) 2014-06-13 2017-04-19 Illumina Cambridge Limited Methods and compositions for preparing sequencing libraries
EP3636342B1 (en) * 2014-06-17 2021-04-28 Life Technologies Corporation Method for preparing a reagent cartridge
US10017759B2 (en) 2014-06-26 2018-07-10 Illumina, Inc. Library preparation of tagged nucleic acid
AU2015279794B2 (en) 2014-06-27 2021-09-30 Illumina, Inc. Modified polymerases for improved incorporation of nucleotide analogues
ES2713153T3 (en) 2014-06-30 2019-05-20 Illumina Inc Methods and compositions that use unilateral transposition
EP3828279B1 (en) 2014-07-15 2022-11-16 Illumina, Inc. Biochemically activated electronic device
CN112941065A (en) 2014-07-21 2021-06-11 亿明达股份有限公司 Polynucleotide enrichment Using CRISPR-CAS System
GB201414098D0 (en) 2014-08-08 2014-09-24 Illumina Cambridge Ltd Modified nucleotide linkers
US9982250B2 (en) 2014-08-21 2018-05-29 Illumina Cambridge Limited Reversible surface functionalization
WO2016040446A1 (en) 2014-09-10 2016-03-17 Good Start Genetics, Inc. Methods for selectively suppressing non-target sequences
WO2016040602A1 (en) 2014-09-11 2016-03-17 Epicentre Technologies Corporation Reduced representation bisulfite sequencing using uracil n-glycosylase (ung) and endonuclease iv
US10633694B2 (en) 2014-09-12 2020-04-28 Illumina, Inc. Compositions, systems, and methods for detecting the presence of polymer subunits using chemiluminescence
WO2016044233A1 (en) 2014-09-18 2016-03-24 Illumina, Inc. Methods and systems for analyzing nucleic acid sequencing data
JP2017536087A (en) 2014-09-24 2017-12-07 グッド スタート ジェネティクス, インコーポレイテッド Process control to increase the robustness of genetic assays
CN107002051A (en) 2014-09-30 2017-08-01 亿明达股份有限公司 The polymerase through modification for the improved incorporation of nucleotide analog
AU2015330688B2 (en) 2014-10-09 2021-02-11 Illumina, Inc. Method and device for separating immiscible liquids to effectively isolate at least one of the liquids
US9897791B2 (en) 2014-10-16 2018-02-20 Illumina, Inc. Optical scanning systems for in situ genetic analysis
WO2016061517A2 (en) 2014-10-17 2016-04-21 Illumina Cambridge Limited Contiguity preserving transposition
EP3213137A4 (en) * 2014-10-29 2018-05-02 Lumencor, Inc. Integrated fluorescence scanning system
EP3632944B1 (en) 2014-10-31 2021-12-01 Illumina Cambridge Limited Polymers and dna copolymer coatings
US10181190B2 (en) * 2014-11-04 2019-01-15 Olympus Corporation Microscope and microscope image acquisition method
US10000799B2 (en) 2014-11-04 2018-06-19 Boreal Genomics, Inc. Methods of sequencing with linked fragments
CN107250358B (en) 2014-11-05 2021-03-30 伊卢米纳剑桥有限公司 Use of siderophore chelators to reduce DNA damage during sample preparation and sequencing
GB201419731D0 (en) 2014-11-05 2014-12-17 Illumina Cambridge Ltd Sequencing from multiple primers to increase data rate and density
PT3218511T (en) 2014-11-11 2020-07-23 Illumina Cambridge Ltd Methods and arrays for producing and sequencing monoclonal clusters of nucleic acid
EP3218513B1 (en) 2014-11-11 2018-10-31 Illumina, Inc. Polynucleotide amplification using crispr-cas systems
ES2870097T3 (en) 2014-12-15 2021-10-26 Illumina Inc Single molecular placement method on a substrate
US10711294B2 (en) * 2014-12-26 2020-07-14 Hitachi High-Tech Corporation Nucleic acid analysis device
CA3010579A1 (en) 2015-01-06 2016-07-14 Good Start Genetics, Inc. Screening for structural variants
CA2972958A1 (en) 2015-01-07 2016-07-14 David BARBIE Microfluidic cell culture of patient-derived tumor cell spheroids
US10669304B2 (en) 2015-02-04 2020-06-02 Twist Bioscience Corporation Methods and devices for de novo oligonucleic acid assembly
WO2016125281A1 (en) * 2015-02-05 2016-08-11 株式会社ニコン Structured illumination microscope, observation method, and control program
EP3254057A4 (en) * 2015-02-06 2019-01-16 Intelligent Imaging Innovations, Inc. Improved illuminator for multi-focus confocal imaging and optimized filling of a spatial light modulator for microscopy
CA2975739C (en) 2015-02-10 2022-12-06 Illumina, Inc. Methods and compositions for analyzing cellular components
US9723765B2 (en) 2015-02-17 2017-08-01 Manufacturing Resources International, Inc. Perimeter ventilation system for electronic display
WO2016154038A1 (en) 2015-03-20 2016-09-29 Illumina, Inc. Fluidics cartridge for use in the vertical or substantially vertical position
EP3274692B1 (en) 2015-03-24 2022-08-10 Illumina, Inc. Methods for imaging samples for biological or chemical analysis
WO2016156845A1 (en) 2015-03-31 2016-10-06 Illumina Cambridge Limited Surface concatamerization of templates
ES2972835T3 (en) 2015-04-10 2024-06-17 10X Genomics Sweden Ab Multiplex analysis of biological specimens of spatially distinguished nucleic acids
EP3283870B1 (en) 2015-04-14 2020-05-06 Illumina, Inc. Structured substrates for improving detection of light emissions and methods relating to the same
US9981239B2 (en) 2015-04-21 2018-05-29 Twist Bioscience Corporation Devices and methods for oligonucleic acid library synthesis
GB201507021D0 (en) 2015-04-24 2015-06-10 Isis Innovation Compact microscope
US10844428B2 (en) 2015-04-28 2020-11-24 Illumina, Inc. Error suppression in sequenced DNA fragments using redundant reads with unique molecular indices (UMIS)
US10989661B2 (en) * 2015-05-01 2021-04-27 The Board Of Regents Of The University Of Texas System Uniform and scalable light-sheets generated by extended focusing
CA2983932C (en) 2015-05-11 2023-07-25 Illumina, Inc. Platform for discovery and analysis of therapeutic agents
US10787704B2 (en) 2015-05-12 2020-09-29 Illumina, Inc. Field-effect apparatus and methods for sequencing nucleic acids
EP3303584B1 (en) 2015-05-29 2019-10-09 Epicentre Technologies Corporation Methods of analyzing nucleic acids
EP3303614B1 (en) 2015-05-29 2020-03-11 Illumina Cambridge Limited Enhanced utilization of surface primers in clusters
BR112017025587B1 (en) 2015-05-29 2022-09-27 Illumina, Inc SAMPLE CARRIER AND ASSAY SYSTEM TO CONDUCT DESIGNATED REACTIONS
IL255758B (en) 2015-06-03 2022-07-01 Illumina Inc Compositions, systems, and methods for sequencing polynucleotides using tethers anchored to polymerases adjacent to nanopores
EP3310933B1 (en) 2015-06-17 2020-11-18 The Translational Genomics Research Institute Methods for obtaining biological molecules from a sample
WO2016210340A1 (en) 2015-06-26 2016-12-29 Li-Cor, Inc. Fluorescence biopsy specimen imager and methods
WO2017007757A1 (en) 2015-07-06 2017-01-12 Illumina, Inc. Balanced ac modulation for driving droplet operations electrodes
EP3878974A1 (en) 2015-07-06 2021-09-15 Illumina Cambridge Limited Sample preparation for nucleic acid amplification
CN107924121B (en) 2015-07-07 2021-06-08 亿明达股份有限公司 Selective surface patterning via nanoimprinting
CN107835857A (en) 2015-07-17 2018-03-23 亿明达股份有限公司 For the polymer sheet layer of application to be sequenced
CA3242290A1 (en) 2015-07-27 2017-02-02 Illumina, Inc. Spatial mapping of nucleic acid sequence information
IL255445B (en) 2015-07-30 2022-07-01 Illumina Inc Orthogonal deblocking of nucleotides
DK3334839T3 (en) * 2015-08-14 2021-04-26 Illumina Inc SYSTEMS AND PROCEDURES USING MAGNETIC REACTIVE SENSORS FOR DETERMINING A GENETIC PROPERTY
WO2017034868A1 (en) 2015-08-24 2017-03-02 Illumina, Inc. In-line pressure accumulator and flow-control system for biological or chemical assays
CN115928221A (en) 2015-08-28 2023-04-07 Illumina公司 Single cell nucleic acid sequence analysis
WO2017037078A1 (en) 2015-09-02 2017-03-09 Illumina Cambridge Limited Systems and methods of improving droplet operations in fluidic systems
US10647981B1 (en) 2015-09-08 2020-05-12 Bio-Rad Laboratories, Inc. Nucleic acid library generation methods and compositions
US10450598B2 (en) 2015-09-11 2019-10-22 Illumina, Inc. Systems and methods for obtaining a droplet having a designated concentration of a substance-of-interest
US10844373B2 (en) 2015-09-18 2020-11-24 Twist Bioscience Corporation Oligonucleic acid variant libraries and synthesis thereof
WO2017053450A1 (en) 2015-09-22 2017-03-30 Twist Bioscience Corporation Flexible substrates for nucleic acid synthesis
AU2016349288A1 (en) * 2015-11-03 2018-05-31 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Method and apparatus for volumetric imaging of a three-dimensional nucleic acid containing matrix
US10253352B2 (en) 2015-11-17 2019-04-09 Omniome, Inc. Methods for determining sequence profiles
US10675627B2 (en) * 2015-11-17 2020-06-09 The Regents Of The University Of California Ferromagnet infused microstructure array
WO2017095917A1 (en) 2015-12-01 2017-06-08 Illumina, Inc. Digital microfluidic system for single-cell isolation and characterization of analytes
US10377538B2 (en) 2015-12-01 2019-08-13 Illumina, Inc. Liquid storage and delivery mechanisms and methods
CN115881230A (en) 2015-12-17 2023-03-31 伊路敏纳公司 Differentiating methylation levels in complex biological samples
JP2019508669A (en) 2016-01-11 2019-03-28 イラミーナ インコーポレーテッド Microfluorometer, fluid system, and detection device having a flow cell latch clamp module
EP3423886B1 (en) 2016-03-04 2022-02-16 Manufacturing Resources International, Inc. Cooling system for double sided display assembly
US10509215B2 (en) * 2016-03-14 2019-12-17 Olympus Corporation Light-field microscope
CN110702652A (en) 2016-03-24 2020-01-17 伊鲁米那股份有限公司 Apparatus and compositions for use in luminescence imaging and methods of use thereof
US11021742B2 (en) 2016-03-28 2021-06-01 Boreal Genomics, Inc. Linked-fragment sequencing
EP3831484B1 (en) 2016-03-28 2024-05-01 Illumina, Inc. Multi-plane microarrays
US10961573B2 (en) 2016-03-28 2021-03-30 Boreal Genomics, Inc. Linked duplex target capture
CN105861293B (en) * 2016-04-06 2017-11-07 深圳市瀚海基因生物科技有限公司 Unimolecule gene sequencer
WO2017177017A1 (en) 2016-04-07 2017-10-12 Omniome, Inc. Methods of quantifying target nucleic acids and identifying sequence variants
ES2786974T3 (en) 2016-04-07 2020-10-14 Illumina Inc Methods and systems for the construction of standard nucleic acid libraries
US10876970B2 (en) 2016-04-12 2020-12-29 The Board Of Regents Of The University Of Texas System Light-sheet microscope with parallelized 3D image acquisition
KR102356022B1 (en) 2016-04-22 2022-01-27 일루미나, 인코포레이티드 Photonic structures-based devices and compositions for use in luminescent imaging of multiple sites within a pixel, and methods of using the same
US10982264B2 (en) 2016-04-22 2021-04-20 Omniome, Inc. Nucleic acid sequencing method and system employing enhanced detection of nucleotide-specific ternary complex formation
CN116200465A (en) 2016-04-25 2023-06-02 哈佛学院董事及会员团体 Hybrid chain reaction method for in situ molecular detection
US10597643B2 (en) 2016-04-29 2020-03-24 Omniome, Inc. Polymerases engineered to reduce nucleotide-independent DNA binding
AU2017258619B2 (en) 2016-04-29 2020-05-14 Pacific Biosciences Of California, Inc. Sequencing method employing ternary complex destabilization to identify cognate nucleotides
AU2017258523B2 (en) 2016-04-29 2020-08-13 Pacific Biosciences Of California, Inc. Method of Nucleic Acid sequence determination
EP4269611A3 (en) 2016-05-11 2024-01-17 Illumina, Inc. Polynucleotide enrichment and amplification using argonaute systems
JP6650342B2 (en) 2016-05-16 2020-02-19 オリンパス株式会社 Microscope system
AU2017267653B2 (en) 2016-05-18 2021-05-13 Illumina, Inc. Self assembled patterning using patterned Hydrophobic surfaces
ES2897550T3 (en) 2016-06-16 2022-03-01 Univ Johns Hopkins Epigenetic analysis methods and system
WO2017223378A1 (en) 2016-06-23 2017-12-28 Li-Cor, Inc. Complementary color flashing for multichannel image presentation
AU2017299803B2 (en) 2016-07-22 2023-06-29 Illumina, Inc. Single cell whole genome libraries and combinatorial indexing methods of making thereof
WO2018035134A1 (en) 2016-08-15 2018-02-22 Omniome, Inc. Method and system for sequencing nucleic acids
US10428378B2 (en) 2016-08-15 2019-10-01 Omniome, Inc. Sequencing method for rapid identification and processing of cognate nucleotide pairs
EP3507364A4 (en) 2016-08-31 2020-05-20 President and Fellows of Harvard College Methods of generating libraries of nucleic acid sequences for detection via fluorescent in situ sequencing
JP7057348B2 (en) 2016-08-31 2022-04-19 プレジデント アンド フェローズ オブ ハーバード カレッジ A method of combining biomolecule detection with a single assay using fluorescent in situ sequencing
KR102217487B1 (en) 2016-09-21 2021-02-23 트위스트 바이오사이언스 코포레이션 Nucleic acid-based data storage
WO2018064116A1 (en) 2016-09-28 2018-04-05 Illumina, Inc. Methods and systems for data compression
WO2018067472A1 (en) 2016-10-03 2018-04-12 Illumina, Inc. Fluorescent detection of amines and hydrazines and assaying methods thereof
CN111781139B (en) 2016-10-14 2023-09-12 亿明达股份有限公司 Clamping box assembly
PL3529380T3 (en) 2016-10-19 2022-10-24 Illumina, Inc. Methods for chemical ligation of nucleic acids
JP7113838B2 (en) 2016-11-16 2022-08-05 イルミナ インコーポレイテッド Enabling method and system for array variant calling
GB201619458D0 (en) 2016-11-17 2017-01-04 Spatial Transcriptomics Ab Method for spatial tagging and analysing nucleic acids in a biological specimen
EP3545488A1 (en) 2016-11-23 2019-10-02 Li-Cor, Inc. Motion-adaptive interactive imaging method
EP4119663A1 (en) 2016-12-09 2023-01-18 The Broad Institute, Inc. Crispr effector system based diagnostics
JP7048609B2 (en) 2016-12-09 2022-04-05 ボリアル ジェノミクス, インコーポレイテッド Linked ligation
JP7051869B2 (en) 2016-12-22 2022-04-11 イラミーナ インコーポレーテッド Array containing sequencing primers and non-sequencing entities
KR102624409B1 (en) 2016-12-22 2024-01-11 일루미나, 인코포레이티드 Arrays with quality control tracers
CN110248725B (en) 2016-12-22 2022-08-02 伊鲁米那股份有限公司 Array comprising resin film and patterned polymer layer
EP3562962B1 (en) 2016-12-30 2022-01-05 Omniome, Inc. Method and system employing distinguishable polymerases for detecting ternary complexes and identifying cognate nucleotides
CN106676654A (en) * 2016-12-30 2017-05-17 广东工业大学 3D printing accuracy control system
CN108265003A (en) * 2016-12-30 2018-07-10 广州康昕瑞基因健康科技有限公司 Multichannel gene sequencing reaction cell and multichannel gene sequencing reaction device
CN108265004A (en) * 2016-12-30 2018-07-10 广州康昕瑞基因健康科技有限公司 The adapter of multichannel sequencing reaction small chamber
CN108265112B (en) * 2016-12-30 2023-04-25 深圳市真迈生物科技有限公司 Method for controlling sequencing reaction, sequencing system and control device
GB201704747D0 (en) 2017-01-05 2017-05-10 Illumina Inc Reagent mixing system and methods
GB201704761D0 (en) * 2017-01-05 2017-05-10 Illumina Inc Common line selector valve for a system
GB201704766D0 (en) 2017-01-05 2017-05-10 Illumia Inc System and methods for selective effluent collection
GB201704772D0 (en) * 2017-01-05 2017-05-10 Illumina Inc Automated volumetric reagent delivery testing
GB201704763D0 (en) * 2017-01-05 2017-05-10 Illumina Inc
GB201704754D0 (en) 2017-01-05 2017-05-10 Illumina Inc Kinetic exclusion amplification of nucleic acid libraries
GB201704758D0 (en) 2017-01-05 2017-05-10 Illumina Inc Reagent channel mixing systema and method
GB201704768D0 (en) 2017-01-05 2017-05-10 Illumina Inc Flow cell liquid degassing systema and method
WO2018128544A1 (en) 2017-01-06 2018-07-12 Agendia N.V. Biomarkers for selecting patient groups, and uses thereof.
CA3049142A1 (en) 2017-01-06 2018-07-12 Illumina, Inc. Phasing correction
AU2018208462B2 (en) 2017-01-10 2021-07-29 Pacific Biosciences Of California, Inc. Polymerases engineered to reduce nucleotide-independent DNA binding
JP6806909B2 (en) 2017-01-17 2021-01-06 イルミナ インコーポレイテッド Determining tumorigenic splicing variants
SG11201906428SA (en) 2017-01-18 2019-08-27 Illumina Inc Methods and systems for generation and error-correction of unique molecular index sets with heterogeneous molecular lengths
CN110177884B (en) 2017-01-20 2021-08-06 欧姆尼欧美公司 Genotyping by polymerase binding
EP3571319A1 (en) 2017-01-20 2019-11-27 Omniome, Inc. Process for cognate nucleotide detection in a nucleic acid sequencing workflow
EP3571313B1 (en) 2017-01-20 2020-12-23 Omniome, Inc. Allele-specific capture of nucleic acids
GB201701688D0 (en) * 2017-02-01 2017-03-15 Illumia Inc System and method with fiducials in non-recliner layouts
EP3576868A4 (en) 2017-02-01 2021-03-17 Illumina, Inc. System and method with fiducials responding to multiple excitation frequencies
GB201701691D0 (en) 2017-02-01 2017-03-15 Illumina Inc System and method with reflective fiducials
GB201701686D0 (en) 2017-02-01 2017-03-15 Illunina Inc System & method with fiducials having offset layouts
GB201701689D0 (en) 2017-02-01 2017-03-15 Illumia Inc System and method with fiducials of non-closed shapes
WO2018152162A1 (en) 2017-02-15 2018-08-23 Omniome, Inc. Distinguishing sequences by detecting polymerase dissociation
US20190360051A1 (en) 2017-02-17 2019-11-28 Stichting Vumc Swarm intelligence-enhanced diagnosis and therapy selection for cancer using tumor- educated platelets
AU2018225503B2 (en) 2017-02-21 2024-07-18 Illumina Cambridge Limited Tagmentation using immobilized transposomes with linkers
CA3054303A1 (en) 2017-02-22 2018-08-30 Twist Bioscience Corporation Nucleic acid based data storage
US11021740B2 (en) 2017-03-15 2021-06-01 The Broad Institute, Inc. Devices for CRISPR effector system based diagnostics
US11174515B2 (en) 2017-03-15 2021-11-16 The Broad Institute, Inc. CRISPR effector system based diagnostics
US11104937B2 (en) 2017-03-15 2021-08-31 The Broad Institute, Inc. CRISPR effector system based diagnostics
KR20190140918A (en) 2017-03-15 2019-12-20 더 브로드 인스티튜트, 인코퍼레이티드 CRISPR effector system-based diagnostics for virus detection
KR102548274B1 (en) 2017-03-20 2023-06-27 일루미나, 인코포레이티드 Methods and compositions for preparing nucleic acid libraries
EP4053294A1 (en) 2017-03-24 2022-09-07 Life Technologies Corporation Polynucleotide adapters and methods of use thereof
CN110603596B (en) 2017-03-30 2023-09-29 Illumina公司 Genome data analysis system and method
JP7284095B2 (en) 2017-03-31 2023-05-30 デイナ ファーバー キャンサー インスティチュート,インコーポレイテッド A method for evaluating tumor cell spheroids using a 3D microfluidic cell culture device
US10737267B2 (en) 2017-04-04 2020-08-11 Omniome, Inc. Fluidic apparatus and methods useful for chemical and biological reactions
CN110494222B (en) 2017-04-06 2021-12-21 伊鲁米那股份有限公司 In situ fluid inspection
SG11201909916YA (en) 2017-04-23 2019-11-28 Illumina Cambridge Ltd Compositions and methods for improving sample identification in indexed nucleic acid libraries
EP3842545B1 (en) 2017-04-23 2022-11-30 Illumina, Inc. Compositions and methods for improving sample identification in indexed nucleic acid libraries
CN111094584A (en) 2017-04-23 2020-05-01 伊鲁米那股份有限公司 Compositions and methods for improving sample identification in indexed nucleic acid libraries
CN110785492B (en) 2017-04-23 2024-04-30 伊鲁米纳剑桥有限公司 Compositions and methods for improved sample identification in indexed nucleic acid libraries
US9951385B1 (en) 2017-04-25 2018-04-24 Omniome, Inc. Methods and apparatus that increase sequencing-by-binding efficiency
WO2018200261A1 (en) 2017-04-25 2018-11-01 Li-Cor, Inc. Top-down and rotational side view biopsy specimen imager and methods
US10161003B2 (en) 2017-04-25 2018-12-25 Omniome, Inc. Methods and apparatus that increase sequencing-by-binding efficiency
US10485113B2 (en) 2017-04-27 2019-11-19 Manufacturing Resources International, Inc. Field serviceable and replaceable display
AU2018258497B2 (en) 2017-04-27 2020-10-15 Manufacturing Resources International, Inc. System and method for preventing display bowing
EP3619326A1 (en) 2017-05-01 2020-03-11 Illumina, Inc. Optimal index sequences for multiplex massively parallel sequencing
CN110832087A (en) 2017-05-08 2020-02-21 伊鲁米那股份有限公司 Universal short adaptors for indexing of polynucleotide samples
FI3981884T3 (en) 2017-06-07 2023-09-21 Univ Oregon Health & Science Single cell whole genome libraries for methylation sequencing
AU2018284227B2 (en) 2017-06-12 2024-05-02 Twist Bioscience Corporation Methods for seamless nucleic acid assembly
WO2018231864A1 (en) 2017-06-12 2018-12-20 Twist Bioscience Corporation Methods for seamless nucleic acid assembly
CN111032882A (en) 2017-06-20 2020-04-17 伊鲁米那股份有限公司 Methods and compositions for addressing inefficiencies in amplification reactions
AU2018302034B2 (en) 2017-07-18 2021-05-20 Pacific Biosciences Of California, Inc. Method of chemically modifying plastic surfaces
CN111315863A (en) * 2017-07-26 2020-06-19 穆罕默德·穆罕默德·阿德尔·艾尔·索格里 DNA sequencer based on concentration
WO2019027767A1 (en) 2017-07-31 2019-02-07 Illumina Inc. Sequencing system with multiplexed biological sample aggregation
US20220411859A1 (en) 2017-08-01 2022-12-29 Illumina, Inc. Hydrogel beads for nucleotide sequencing
WO2019028047A1 (en) 2017-08-01 2019-02-07 Illumina, Inc Spatial indexing of genetic material and library preparation using hydrogel beads and flow cells
CN118086480A (en) * 2017-08-01 2024-05-28 深圳华大智造科技有限公司 Nucleic acid sequencing method
WO2019023924A1 (en) 2017-08-01 2019-02-07 Helitec Limited Methods of enriching and determining target nucleotide sequences
CN114563419A (en) * 2017-08-15 2022-05-31 加利福尼亚太平洋生物科学股份有限公司 Scanning device and method for detecting chemical and biological analytes
EP3669018A4 (en) 2017-08-18 2021-05-26 Nautilus Biotechnology, Inc. Methods of selecting binding reagents
CN111566125A (en) 2017-09-11 2020-08-21 特韦斯特生物科学公司 GPCR binding proteins and synthesis thereof
US11447818B2 (en) 2017-09-15 2022-09-20 Illumina, Inc. Universal short adapters with variable length non-random unique molecular identifiers
US10559965B2 (en) 2017-09-21 2020-02-11 Manufacturing Resources International, Inc. Display assembly having multiple charging ports
CN110870020A (en) 2017-10-16 2020-03-06 因美纳有限公司 Aberrant splicing detection using Convolutional Neural Network (CNNS)
KR102416048B1 (en) 2017-10-16 2022-07-04 일루미나, 인코포레이티드 Deep convolutional neural networks for variant classification
AU2018353136B2 (en) 2017-10-19 2022-05-19 Pacific Biosciences Of California, Inc. Simultaneous background reduction and complex stabilization in binding assay workflows
US10894242B2 (en) 2017-10-20 2021-01-19 Twist Bioscience Corporation Heated nanowells for polynucleotide synthesis
WO2019099306A1 (en) 2017-11-14 2019-05-23 Illumina, Inc. Droplet dispensing
IL275818B2 (en) 2018-01-04 2024-10-01 Twist Bioscience Corp Dna-based digital information storage
WO2019136376A1 (en) 2018-01-08 2019-07-11 Illumina, Inc. High-throughput sequencing with semiconductor-based detection
KR102494589B1 (en) 2018-01-08 2023-02-07 일루미나, 인코포레이티드 High-throughput sequencing with semiconductor-based detection
NL2020618B1 (en) * 2018-01-12 2019-07-18 Illumina Inc Real time controller switching
EP3901833A1 (en) 2018-01-15 2021-10-27 Illumina, Inc. Deep learning-based variant classifier
WO2019148206A1 (en) 2018-01-29 2019-08-01 The Broad Institute, Inc. Crispr effector system based diagnostics
EP3749777A4 (en) 2018-02-06 2021-11-24 Omniome, Inc. Compositions and techniques for nucleic acid primer extension
WO2019157492A1 (en) 2018-02-12 2019-08-15 Intelligent Imaging Innovations, Inc. Tiling light sheet selective plane illumination microscopy using discontinuous light sheets
KR102437660B1 (en) 2018-02-13 2022-08-29 일루미나, 인코포레이티드 DNA sequencing using hydrogel beads
JP6938690B2 (en) 2018-02-16 2021-09-22 イラミーナ インコーポレーテッド Charge-tagged nucleotides and how to use them
JP7209649B2 (en) 2018-03-29 2023-01-20 イラミーナ インコーポレーテッド Illumination for fluorescence imaging using objectives
JP6974504B2 (en) 2018-04-02 2021-12-01 イルミナ インコーポレイテッド Compositions and Methods for Making Controls for Sequence-Based Genetic Testing
WO2019195379A1 (en) 2018-04-04 2019-10-10 Lifeedit, Inc. Methods and compositions to identify novel crispr systems
US20190318806A1 (en) 2018-04-12 2019-10-17 Illumina, Inc. Variant Classifier Based on Deep Neural Networks
WO2019203986A1 (en) 2018-04-19 2019-10-24 Omniome, Inc. Improving accuracy of base calls in nucleic acid sequencing methods
KR102481869B1 (en) 2018-04-20 2022-12-27 일루미나, 인코포레이티드 Methods of encapsulating single cells, the encapsulated cells and uses thereof
AU2019261218A1 (en) 2018-04-26 2020-11-26 Pacific Biosciences Of California, Inc. Methods and compositions for stabilizing nucleic acid-nucleotide-polymerase complexes
WO2019209776A1 (en) 2018-04-27 2019-10-31 Corning Incorporated Microfluidic devices and methods for manufacturing microfluidic devices
WO2019221913A1 (en) * 2018-05-15 2019-11-21 Illumina, Inc. Flow cell with flexible connection
CN111065645A (en) 2018-05-15 2020-04-24 伊鲁米纳公司 Compositions and methods for chemical cleavage and deprotection of surface-bound oligonucleotides
KR102447811B1 (en) 2018-05-17 2022-09-27 일루미나, 인코포레이티드 High-throughput single-cell sequencing with reduced amplification bias
CN112639130B (en) 2018-05-18 2024-08-09 特韦斯特生物科学公司 Polynucleotides, reagents and methods for nucleic acid hybridization
KR102605749B1 (en) 2018-05-25 2023-11-23 일루미나, 인코포레이티드 Circulating rna signatures specific to preeclamsia
JP2021525078A (en) 2018-05-31 2021-09-24 オムニオム インコーポレイテッドOmniome, Inc. Increased signal vs. noise in nucleic acid sequencing
US11180794B2 (en) 2018-05-31 2021-11-23 Omniome, Inc. Methods and compositions for capping nucleic acids
FI3810774T3 (en) 2018-06-04 2023-12-11 Illumina Inc Methods of making high-throughput single-cell transcriptome libraries
US10690486B2 (en) 2018-07-03 2020-06-23 Amo Development, Llc Water-immersed high precision laser focus spot size measurement apparatus
NL2021377B1 (en) 2018-07-03 2020-01-08 Illumina Inc Interposer with first and second adhesive layers
US12073922B2 (en) 2018-07-11 2024-08-27 Illumina, Inc. Deep learning-based framework for identifying sequence patterns that cause sequence-specific errors (SSEs)
US11378808B2 (en) 2018-07-18 2022-07-05 Idex Health & Science Llc Laser systems and optical devices for laser beam shaping
WO2020023362A1 (en) 2018-07-24 2020-01-30 Omniome, Inc. Serial formation of ternary complex species
WO2020022891A2 (en) 2018-07-26 2020-01-30 Stichting Vumc Biomarkers for atrial fibrillation
WO2020028194A1 (en) 2018-07-30 2020-02-06 Readcoor, Inc. Methods and systems for sample processing or analysis
US10602626B2 (en) 2018-07-30 2020-03-24 Manufacturing Resources International, Inc. Housing assembly for an integrated display unit
CA3106035A1 (en) 2018-08-07 2020-02-13 The Broad Institute, Inc. Cas12b enzymes and systems
EP3837381A1 (en) 2018-08-15 2021-06-23 Illumina, Inc. Compositions and methods for improving library enrichment
WO2020039261A1 (en) 2018-08-23 2020-02-27 Boreal Genomics, Inc. Linked target capture and ligation
US11242512B2 (en) 2018-09-17 2022-02-08 Omniome, Inc. Engineered polymerases for improved sequencing
WO2020072816A1 (en) 2018-10-03 2020-04-09 The Broad Institute, Inc. Crispr effector system based diagnostics for hemorrhagic fever detection
WO2020076976A1 (en) 2018-10-10 2020-04-16 Readcoor, Inc. Three-dimensional spatial molecular indexing
SG11201911777QA (en) 2018-10-15 2020-05-28 Illumina Inc Deep learning-based techniques for pre-training deep convolutional neural networks
US11085036B2 (en) 2018-10-26 2021-08-10 Illumina, Inc. Modulating polymer beads for DNA processing
KR20210084349A (en) 2018-10-31 2021-07-07 일루미나, 인코포레이티드 Polymerases, compositions, and methods of use
JP2022043362A (en) * 2018-11-12 2022-03-16 株式会社日立ハイテク Nucleic acid analysis device
US20240011086A1 (en) 2018-11-15 2024-01-11 Omniome, Inc. Electronic detection of nucleic acid structure
US11993865B2 (en) 2018-11-20 2024-05-28 Nautilus Subsidiary, Inc. Selection of affinity reagents
NL2022043B1 (en) 2018-11-21 2020-06-03 Akershus Univ Hf Tagmentation-Associated Multiplex PCR Enrichment Sequencing
CN118653217A (en) 2018-11-30 2024-09-17 Illumina公司 Analysis of multiple analytes using a single assay
GB2578528B (en) 2018-12-04 2021-02-24 Omniome Inc Mixed-phase fluids for nucleic acid sequencing and other analytical assays
EP3891305A1 (en) 2018-12-05 2021-10-13 Illumina Cambridge Limited Methods and compositions for cluster generation by bridge amplification
BR112020026655A2 (en) 2018-12-05 2021-04-06 Illumina, Inc. POLYMERASES, COMPOSITIONS AND METHODS OF USE
GB201820300D0 (en) 2018-12-13 2019-01-30 10X Genomics Inc Method for spatial tagging and analysing genomic DNA in a biological specimen
GB201820341D0 (en) 2018-12-13 2019-01-30 10X Genomics Inc Method for transposase-mediated spatial tagging and analysing genomic DNA in a biological specimen
KR20210103931A (en) 2018-12-14 2021-08-24 일루미나 케임브리지 리미티드 Reduced pacing by unlabeled nucleotides during sequencing
WO2020126595A1 (en) 2018-12-17 2020-06-25 Illumina Cambridge Limited Primer oligonucleotide for sequencing
EP3899040A1 (en) 2018-12-17 2021-10-27 Illumina Cambridge Limited Compositions for use in polyunucleotide sequencing
SG11202012807YA (en) 2018-12-18 2021-01-28 Illumina Cambridge Ltd Methods and compositions for paired end sequencing using a single surface primer
PL3899037T3 (en) 2018-12-19 2024-04-08 Illumina, Inc. Methods for improving polynucleotide cluster clonality priority
EP3899032A2 (en) 2018-12-20 2021-10-27 Omniome, Inc. Temperature control for analysis of nucleic acids and other analytes
EP3899542A4 (en) * 2018-12-21 2022-09-14 Illumina, Inc. Sensing systems
US11293061B2 (en) 2018-12-26 2022-04-05 Illumina Cambridge Limited Sequencing methods using nucleotides with 3′ AOM blocking group
EP3884071A4 (en) 2019-01-03 2022-04-06 Boreal Genomics, Inc. Linked target capture
AU2020206443A1 (en) 2019-01-11 2021-04-15 Illumina Cambridge Limited Complex surface-bound transposome complexes
US11543353B2 (en) * 2019-01-18 2023-01-03 Essenlix Corporation Multi-mode illumination system
SG11202012753SA (en) 2019-01-29 2021-01-28 Illumina Inc Sequencing kits
MX2020013413A (en) * 2019-01-29 2021-04-28 Illumina Inc Flow cells.
WO2020167574A1 (en) 2019-02-14 2020-08-20 Omniome, Inc. Mitigating adverse impacts of detection systems on nucleic acids and other biological analytes
WO2020172444A1 (en) * 2019-02-20 2020-08-27 Omniome, Inc. Scanning apparatus and methods for detecting chemical and biological analytes
WO2020176680A1 (en) 2019-02-26 2020-09-03 Twist Bioscience Corporation Variant nucleic acid libraries for antibody optimization
US11096317B2 (en) 2019-02-26 2021-08-17 Manufacturing Resources International, Inc. Display assembly with loopback cooling
US20220033805A1 (en) 2019-03-01 2022-02-03 Sanjay Srivatsan High-throughput single-nuclei and single-cell libraries and methods of making and of using
NL2023316B1 (en) 2019-03-21 2020-09-28 Illumina Inc Artificial intelligence-based sequencing
NL2023312B1 (en) 2019-03-21 2020-09-28 Illumina Inc Artificial intelligence-based base calling
WO2020205296A1 (en) 2019-03-21 2020-10-08 Illumina, Inc. Artificial intelligence-based generation of sequencing metadata
US11210554B2 (en) 2019-03-21 2021-12-28 Illumina, Inc. Artificial intelligence-based generation of sequencing metadata
NL2023310B1 (en) 2019-03-21 2020-09-28 Illumina Inc Training data generation for artificial intelligence-based sequencing
NL2023311B9 (en) 2019-03-21 2021-03-12 Illumina Inc Artificial intelligence-based generation of sequencing metadata
NL2023314B1 (en) 2019-03-21 2020-09-28 Illumina Inc Artificial intelligence-based quality scoring
US11347965B2 (en) 2019-03-21 2022-05-31 Illumina, Inc. Training data generation for artificial intelligence-based sequencing
SG10201902905UA (en) * 2019-04-01 2020-11-27 Delta Electronics Int’L Singapore Pte Ltd Thermal cycling system
US10795413B1 (en) 2019-04-03 2020-10-06 Manufacturing Resources International, Inc. Electronic display assembly with a channel for ambient air in an access panel
US11327073B2 (en) 2019-04-12 2022-05-10 Western Digital Technologies, Inc. Thermal sensor array for molecule detection and related detection schemes
US11609208B2 (en) 2019-04-12 2023-03-21 Western Digital Technologies, Inc. Devices and methods for molecule detection based on thermal stabilities of magnetic nanoparticles
US11579217B2 (en) 2019-04-12 2023-02-14 Western Digital Technologies, Inc. Devices and methods for frequency- and phase-based detection of magnetically-labeled molecules using spin torque oscillator (STO) sensors
EP3941625A1 (en) 2019-04-12 2022-01-26 Western Digital Technologies Inc. Nucleic acid sequencing by synthesis using magnetic sensor arrays
US11112468B2 (en) 2019-04-12 2021-09-07 Western Digital Technologies, Inc. Magnetoresistive sensor array for molecule detection and related detection schemes
US11738336B2 (en) 2019-04-12 2023-08-29 Western Digital Technologies, Inc. Spin torque oscillator (STO) sensors used in nucleic acid sequencing arrays and detection schemes for nucleic acid sequencing
US11593649B2 (en) 2019-05-16 2023-02-28 Illumina, Inc. Base calling using convolutions
US11423306B2 (en) 2019-05-16 2022-08-23 Illumina, Inc. Systems and devices for characterization and performance analysis of pixel-based sequencing
WO2020252186A1 (en) 2019-06-11 2020-12-17 Omniome, Inc. Calibrated focus sensing
MX2020014057A (en) 2019-06-19 2021-05-27 Illumina Inc Reagent exchange in an instrument.
CN114729342A (en) 2019-06-21 2022-07-08 特韦斯特生物科学公司 Barcode-based nucleic acid sequence assembly
CA3125305A1 (en) 2019-07-12 2021-01-21 Illumina Cambridge Limited Nucleic acid library preparation using electrophoresis
SG11202105836XA (en) 2019-07-12 2021-07-29 Illumina Cambridge Ltd Compositions and methods for preparing nucleic acid sequencing libraries using crispr/cas9 immobilized on a solid support
WO2021011803A1 (en) 2019-07-16 2021-01-21 Omniome, Inc. Synthetic nucleic acids having non-natural structures
US10656368B1 (en) 2019-07-24 2020-05-19 Omniome, Inc. Method and system for biological imaging using a wide field objective lens
US11180520B2 (en) 2019-09-10 2021-11-23 Omniome, Inc. Reversible modifications of nucleotides
WO2021050962A1 (en) 2019-09-11 2021-03-18 The United States Of America, As Represented By The Secretary, Department Of Health And Human Services Cancer detection and classification
US11208682B2 (en) * 2019-09-13 2021-12-28 Western Digital Technologies, Inc. Enhanced optical detection for nucleic acid sequencing using thermally-dependent fluorophore tags
CA3155629A1 (en) 2019-09-23 2021-04-01 Twist Bioscience Corporation Variant nucleic acid libraries for crth2
AU2019467369B2 (en) 2019-09-24 2023-10-19 Mgi Tech Co., Ltd. Biochemical substance analysis system, method, and device
EP4045683A1 (en) 2019-10-18 2022-08-24 Omniome, Inc. Methods and compositions for capping nucleic acids
WO2021080811A1 (en) * 2019-10-23 2021-04-29 Corning Incorporated Glass articles including flow channels and methods of making the same
US20210139867A1 (en) 2019-11-08 2021-05-13 Omniome, Inc. Engineered polymerases for improved sequencing by binding
CA3131748A1 (en) 2019-11-22 2021-05-27 Sarah E. SHULTZABERGER Circulating rna signatures specific to preeclampsia
US11747329B2 (en) 2019-11-22 2023-09-05 Western Digital Technologies, Inc. Magnetic gradient concentrator/reluctance detector for molecule detection
DE202019106695U1 (en) 2019-12-02 2020-03-19 Omniome, Inc. System for sequencing nucleic acids in fluid foam
DE202019106694U1 (en) 2019-12-02 2020-03-19 Omniome, Inc. System for sequencing nucleic acids in fluid foam
EP4219755A3 (en) * 2019-12-02 2023-08-23 Illumina Cambridge Limited Time-based cluster imaging of amplified contiguity preserved library fragments of genomic dna
US20210172012A1 (en) 2019-12-04 2021-06-10 Illumina, Inc. Preparation of dna sequencing libraries for detection of dna pathogens in plasma
WO2021118349A1 (en) 2019-12-10 2021-06-17 Prinses Máxima Centrum Voor Kinderoncologie B.V. Methods of typing germ cell tumors
JP7500727B2 (en) 2019-12-18 2024-06-17 エフ. ホフマン-ラ ロシュ アーゲー Sequencing-by-synthesis method using sequential labeling schemes
MX2021011847A (en) 2019-12-19 2021-11-17 Illumina Inc High-throughput single-cell libraries and methods of making and of using.
US20210187503A1 (en) * 2019-12-19 2021-06-24 Personal Genomics Taiwan, Inc. Apparatus and system for single-molecule nucleic acids detection
US11747262B2 (en) 2019-12-23 2023-09-05 Singular Genomics Systems, Inc. Flow cell carrier and methods of use
US11498078B2 (en) 2019-12-23 2022-11-15 Singular Genomics Systems, Inc. Flow cell receiver and methods of use
US20210189483A1 (en) 2019-12-23 2021-06-24 Mgi Tech Co. Ltd. Controlled strand-displacement for paired end sequencing
US12110548B2 (en) 2020-02-03 2024-10-08 10X Genomics, Inc. Bi-directional in situ analysis
EP4100161B1 (en) 2020-02-04 2024-07-10 Pacific Biosciences of California, Inc. Flow cells and methods for their use
US20210265015A1 (en) 2020-02-20 2021-08-26 Illumina, Inc. Hardware Execution and Acceleration of Artificial Intelligence-Based Base Caller
AU2021224871A1 (en) 2020-02-20 2022-09-08 Illumina, Inc. Artificial intelligence-based many-to-many base calling
US20210265018A1 (en) 2020-02-20 2021-08-26 Illumina, Inc. Knowledge Distillation and Gradient Pruning-Based Compression of Artificial Intelligence-Based Base Caller
US20210265016A1 (en) 2020-02-20 2021-08-26 Illumina, Inc. Data Compression for Artificial Intelligence-Based Base Calling
CN115516104A (en) 2020-03-03 2022-12-23 加利福尼亚太平洋生物科学股份有限公司 Methods and compositions for sequencing double-stranded nucleic acids
MX2022013499A (en) 2020-04-27 2023-01-16 Twist Bioscience Corp Variant nucleic acid libraries for coronavirus.
EP4143344A1 (en) 2020-04-27 2023-03-08 Agendia N.V. Treatment of her2 negative, mammaprint high risk 2 breast cancer
EP4144745A4 (en) * 2020-04-30 2024-02-21 GeneMind Biosciences Company Limited Sequencing method, analysis method therefor and analysis system thereof, computer-readable storage medium, and electronic device
US20230203592A1 (en) 2020-05-05 2023-06-29 Akershus Universitetssykehus Hf Compositions and methods for characterizing bowel cancer
US20230183798A1 (en) 2020-05-05 2023-06-15 Pacific Biosciences Of California, Inc. Compositions and methods for modifying polymerase-nucleic acid complexes
US11188778B1 (en) 2020-05-05 2021-11-30 Illumina, Inc. Equalization-based image processing and spatial crosstalk attenuator
EP4150065A2 (en) 2020-05-12 2023-03-22 Illumina Inc Generating nucleic acids with modified bases using recombinant terminal deoxynucleotidyl transferase
EP4153775B1 (en) 2020-05-22 2024-07-24 10X Genomics, Inc. Simultaneous spatio-temporal measurement of gene expression and cellular activity
EP4163357A4 (en) * 2020-06-03 2024-02-28 Hitachi High-Tech Corporation Nucleic acid analyzer
US12031177B1 (en) 2020-06-04 2024-07-09 10X Genomics, Inc. Methods of enhancing spatial resolution of transcripts
WO2021252617A1 (en) 2020-06-09 2021-12-16 Illumina, Inc. Methods for increasing yield of sequencing libraries
US11935311B2 (en) 2020-06-11 2024-03-19 Nautilus Subsidiary, Inc. Methods and systems for computational decoding of biological, chemical, and physical entities
BR112022026056A2 (en) 2020-06-22 2023-03-07 Illumina Cambridge Ltd NUCLEOSIDES AND NUCLEOTIDES WITH BLOCKING GROUP 3? ACETAL
KR20230037503A (en) 2020-06-30 2023-03-16 일루미나, 인코포레이티드 Sequencing by catalytically controlled synthesis to generate traceless DNA
KR20230035253A (en) 2020-07-02 2023-03-13 일루미나, 인코포레이티드 How to Calibrate Nucleic Acid Library Seeding Efficiency in a Flow Cell
CA3186976A1 (en) 2020-07-08 2022-01-13 Illumina, Inc. Beads as transposome carriers
CN116171330A (en) 2020-08-06 2023-05-26 Illumina公司 RNA and DNA sequencing libraries using bead-linked transposomes
JP2023537850A (en) 2020-08-18 2023-09-06 イルミナ インコーポレイテッド Sequence-specific targeted transposition and selection and selection of nucleic acids
GB202013141D0 (en) 2020-08-21 2020-10-07 Univ College Cardiff Consultants Ltd A screening method for the detection of DNA damage
US20220067489A1 (en) 2020-08-28 2022-03-03 Illumina, Inc. Detecting and Filtering Clusters Based on Artificial Intelligence-Predicted Base Calls
WO2022053610A1 (en) 2020-09-11 2022-03-17 Illumina Cambridge Limited Methods of enriching a target sequence from a sequencing library using hairpin adaptors
US11477923B2 (en) 2020-10-02 2022-10-18 Manufacturing Resources International, Inc. Field customizable airflow system for a communications box
WO2022086866A1 (en) 2020-10-19 2022-04-28 Twist Bioscience Corporation Methods of synthesizing oligonucleotides using tethered nucleotides
IL302207A (en) 2020-10-21 2023-06-01 Illumina Inc Sequencing templates comprising multiple inserts and compositions and methods for improving sequencing throughput
US11778757B2 (en) 2020-10-23 2023-10-03 Manufacturing Resources International, Inc. Display assemblies incorporating electric vehicle charging equipment
US11470749B2 (en) 2020-10-23 2022-10-11 Manufacturing Resources International, Inc. Forced air cooling for display assemblies using centrifugal fans
EP4200444A4 (en) 2020-10-30 2024-09-25 Singular Genomics Systems Inc Methods and compositions for reducing nucleotide impurities
KR20230118570A (en) 2020-11-11 2023-08-11 노틸러스 서브시디어리, 인크. Affinity reagents with enhanced binding and detection properties
WO2022108790A1 (en) 2020-11-17 2022-05-27 Singular Genomics Systems, Inc. Multiport disconnect couplings
EP4264231A1 (en) 2020-12-16 2023-10-25 Singular Genomics Systems, Inc. Kinematic imaging system
WO2022140291A1 (en) 2020-12-21 2022-06-30 Singular Genomics Systems, Inc. Systems and methods for multicolor imaging
WO2022155331A1 (en) 2021-01-13 2022-07-21 Pacific Biosciences Of California, Inc. Surface structuring with colloidal assembly
AU2022209365A1 (en) 2021-01-21 2023-07-20 Nautilus Subsidiary, Inc. Systems and methods for biomolecule preparation
EP4284944A1 (en) 2021-01-29 2023-12-06 Illumina, Inc. Methods, compositions and kits to improve seeding efficiency of flow cells with polynucleotides
KR20230137394A (en) 2021-02-04 2023-10-04 일루미나, 인코포레이티드 Generation of long indexed-concatenated reads on transposome-bound beads
US20240043915A1 (en) 2021-02-13 2024-02-08 The General Hospital Corporation Methods and compositions for in situ macromolecule detection and uses thereof
WO2022178267A2 (en) 2021-02-19 2022-08-25 10X Genomics, Inc. Modular assay support devices
US11505796B2 (en) 2021-03-11 2022-11-22 Nautilus Biotechnology, Inc. Systems and methods for biomolecule retention
US11884977B2 (en) 2021-03-12 2024-01-30 Singular Genomics Systems, Inc. Nanoarrays and methods of use thereof
EP4263868A1 (en) 2021-03-12 2023-10-25 Singular Genomics Systems, Inc. Nanoarrays and methods of use thereof
WO2022197752A1 (en) 2021-03-16 2022-09-22 Illumina, Inc. Tile location and/or cycle based weight set selection for base calling
CN117222747A (en) 2021-03-22 2023-12-12 伊鲁米纳剑桥有限公司 Methods for improving clonality of nucleic acid clusters
MX2023011219A (en) 2021-03-29 2023-10-02 Illumina Inc Compositions and methods for assessing dna damage in a library and normalizing amplicon size bias.
KR20230161979A (en) 2021-03-29 2023-11-28 일루미나, 인코포레이티드 Improved library manufacturing methods
MX2023010495A (en) 2021-03-30 2023-09-18 Illumina Inc Improved methods of isothermal complementary dna and library preparation.
CN115803816A (en) 2021-03-31 2023-03-14 因美纳有限公司 Artificial intelligence-based base detector with context awareness
CN117015603A (en) 2021-03-31 2023-11-07 Illumina公司 Methods for preparing directed tagged sequencing libraries using transposon-based techniques with unique molecular identifiers for error correction
MX2023011659A (en) 2021-04-02 2023-10-11 Illumina Inc Machine-learning model for detecting a bubble within a nucleotide-sample slide for sequencing.
US20220336054A1 (en) 2021-04-15 2022-10-20 Illumina, Inc. Deep Convolutional Neural Networks to Predict Variant Pathogenicity using Three-Dimensional (3D) Protein Structures
FR3121936A1 (en) 2021-04-20 2022-10-21 Naos Institute Of Life Science METHOD FOR SCREENING TOPICAL ECOBIOLOGICAL INGREDIENTS AND COMPOSITIONS, AND ITS USE TO PERFORM A COSMETIC TREATMENT FOR RESTORING THE CUTANEOUS MICROBIOTA
US12070744B2 (en) 2021-04-22 2024-08-27 Illumina, Inc. Valve assemblies and related systems
EP4334475A1 (en) 2021-05-07 2024-03-13 Agendia N.V. Endocrine treatment of hormone receptor positive breast cancer typed as having a low risk of recurrence
EP4337789A1 (en) 2021-05-10 2024-03-20 Pacific Biosciences of California, Inc. Dna amplification buffer replenishment during rolling circle amplification
WO2022240764A1 (en) 2021-05-10 2022-11-17 Pacific Biosciences Of California, Inc. Single-molecule seeding and amplification on a surface
AU2022277632A1 (en) 2021-05-20 2023-11-09 Illumina Cambridge Limited Compositions and methods for sequencing by synthesis
CN117677435A (en) 2021-06-15 2024-03-08 伊鲁米纳公司 Surface functionalization of non-aqueous gels for sequencing
CN117597453A (en) 2021-06-23 2024-02-23 伊鲁米纳公司 Compositions, methods, kits, cartridges, and systems for sequencing reagents
EP4360097A1 (en) 2021-06-24 2024-05-01 Nautilus Subsidiary, Inc. Methods and systems for assay refinement
WO2022269033A1 (en) 2021-06-25 2022-12-29 Illumina Cambridge Limited Linear fourier fiducial
EP4359122A1 (en) 2021-06-25 2024-05-01 Illumina, Inc. Fiducials for use in registration of a patterned surface
WO2023278184A1 (en) 2021-06-29 2023-01-05 Illumina, Inc. Methods and systems to correct crosstalk in illumination emitted from reaction sites
EP4364155A1 (en) 2021-06-29 2024-05-08 Illumina, Inc. Self-learned base caller, trained using oligo sequences
CA3224393A1 (en) 2021-06-29 2023-01-05 Mitchell A BEKRITSKY Machine-learning model for generating confidence classifications for genomic coordinates
MX2023015504A (en) 2021-06-29 2024-01-22 Illumina Inc Signal-to-noise-ratio metric for determining nucleotide-base calls and base-call quality.
US20230005253A1 (en) 2021-07-01 2023-01-05 Illumina, Inc. Efficient artificial intelligence-based base calling of index sequences
US20230027409A1 (en) 2021-07-13 2023-01-26 Illumina, Inc. Methods and systems for real time extraction of crosstalk in illumination emitted from reaction sites
US11455487B1 (en) 2021-10-26 2022-09-27 Illumina Software, Inc. Intensity extraction and crosstalk attenuation using interpolation and adaptation for base calling
JP2024532004A (en) 2021-07-19 2024-09-04 イルミナ インコーポレイテッド Intensity extraction by interpolation and fitting for base calling
IL310281A (en) * 2021-07-21 2024-03-01 Element Biosciences Inc Optical systems for nucleic acid sequencing and methods thereof
WO2023004357A1 (en) 2021-07-23 2023-01-26 Illumina, Inc. Methods for preparing substrate surface for dna sequencing
US20230021577A1 (en) 2021-07-23 2023-01-26 Illumina Software, Inc. Machine-learning model for recalibrating nucleotide-base calls
JP2024532049A (en) 2021-07-28 2024-09-05 イルミナ インコーポレイテッド Quality score calibration of base calling systems
US11966263B2 (en) 2021-07-28 2024-04-23 Manufacturing Resources International, Inc. Display assemblies for providing compressive forces at electronic display layers
KR20240035413A (en) 2021-08-03 2024-03-15 일루미나, 인코포레이티드 Base calling using the multi-base caller model
US12077789B2 (en) 2021-08-14 2024-09-03 Illumina, Inc. Polymerases, compositions, and methods of use
CN117881795A (en) 2021-08-17 2024-04-12 因美纳有限公司 Methods and compositions for identifying methylated cytosines
US11919393B2 (en) 2021-08-23 2024-03-05 Manufacturing Resources International, Inc. Display assemblies inducing relatively turbulent flow and integrating electric vehicle charging equipment
US11744054B2 (en) 2021-08-23 2023-08-29 Manufacturing Resources International, Inc. Fan unit for providing improved airflow within display assemblies
US11762231B2 (en) 2021-08-23 2023-09-19 Manufacturing Resources International, Inc. Display assemblies inducing turbulent flow
EP4399528A1 (en) 2021-09-09 2024-07-17 Nautilus Subsidiary, Inc. Characterization and localization of protein modifications
GB202112907D0 (en) 2021-09-10 2021-10-27 Res & Innovation Uk Methods of biomolecule display
US20230088338A1 (en) 2021-09-10 2023-03-23 Illumina, Inc. Sequencer focus quality metrics and focus tracking for periodically patterned surfaces
CN117561573A (en) 2021-09-17 2024-02-13 因美纳有限公司 Automatic identification of the source of faults in nucleotide sequencing from base interpretation error patterns
KR20240072970A (en) 2021-09-21 2024-05-24 일루미나, 인코포레이티드 Graph reference genome and base determination approaches using imputed haplotypes.
WO2023049215A1 (en) 2021-09-22 2023-03-30 Illumina, Inc. Compressed state-based base calling
JP2024537689A (en) 2021-09-22 2024-10-16 ノーティラス・サブシディアリー・インコーポレイテッド Methods and systems for determining polypeptide interactions - Patents.com
WO2023056328A2 (en) 2021-09-30 2023-04-06 Illumina, Inc. Solid supports and methods for depleting and/or enriching library fragments prepared from biosamples
US20230096386A1 (en) 2021-09-30 2023-03-30 Illumina Cambridge Limited Polynucleotide sequencing
CA3232183A1 (en) 2021-10-11 2023-04-20 Nautilus Subsidiary, Inc. Highly multiplexable analysis of proteins and proteomes
EP4419705A1 (en) 2021-10-20 2024-08-28 Illumina, Inc. Methods for capturing library dna for sequencing
WO2023081728A1 (en) 2021-11-03 2023-05-11 Nautilus Biotechnology, Inc. Systems and methods for surface structuring
WO2023081485A1 (en) 2021-11-08 2023-05-11 Pacific Biosciences Of California, Inc. Stepwise sequencing of a polynucleotide with a homogenous reaction mixture
WO2023085932A1 (en) 2021-11-10 2023-05-19 Omnigen B.V. Prediction of response following folfirinox treatment in cancer patients
US11968813B2 (en) 2021-11-23 2024-04-23 Manufacturing Resources International, Inc. Display assembly with divided interior space
CN117581303A (en) 2021-12-02 2024-02-20 因美纳有限公司 Generating cluster-specific signal corrections for determining nucleotide base detection
WO2023107622A1 (en) 2021-12-10 2023-06-15 Illumina, Inc. Parallel sample and index sequencing
EP4453250A1 (en) 2021-12-21 2024-10-30 Illumina, Inc. Wax-microsphere matrix compositions and methods of making and using the same
WO2023122363A1 (en) 2021-12-23 2023-06-29 Illumina Software, Inc. Dynamic graphical status summaries for nucelotide sequencing
US20230215515A1 (en) 2021-12-23 2023-07-06 Illumina Software, Inc. Facilitating secure execution of external workflows for genomic sequencing diagnostics
US20230207050A1 (en) 2021-12-28 2023-06-29 Illumina Software, Inc. Machine learning model for recalibrating nucleotide base calls corresponding to target variants
KR20240131386A (en) 2021-12-29 2024-08-30 일루미나, 인코포레이티드 Automatic switching of variant analysis model versions for genomic analysis applications
AU2023208743A1 (en) 2022-01-20 2024-01-04 Illumina, Inc. Methods of detecting methylcytosine and hydroxymethylcytosine by sequencing
AU2023225949A1 (en) 2022-02-25 2024-01-18 Illumina, Inc. Machine-learning models for detecting and adjusting values for nucleotide methylation levels
CN118871994A (en) 2022-02-25 2024-10-29 因美纳有限公司 Calibration sequence for nucleotide sequencing
US11795505B2 (en) 2022-03-10 2023-10-24 Singular Genomics Systems, Inc. Nucleic acid delivery scaffolds
WO2023175013A1 (en) 2022-03-15 2023-09-21 Illumina, Inc. Methods for preparing signals for concurrent sequencing
AU2023240337A1 (en) 2022-03-22 2024-01-18 Illumina, Inc. Substrate with orthogonally functional nanodomains
WO2023183937A1 (en) 2022-03-25 2023-09-28 Illumina, Inc. Sequence-to-sequence base calling
US12092578B2 (en) 2022-03-29 2024-09-17 Nautilus Subsidiary, Inc. Integrated arrays for single-analyte processes
CA3223722A1 (en) 2022-04-07 2023-10-12 Illumina, Inc. Altered cytidine deaminases and methods of use
WO2023212490A1 (en) 2022-04-25 2023-11-02 Nautilus Subsidiary, Inc. Systems and methods for assessing and improving the quality of multiplex molecular assays
WO2023212601A1 (en) 2022-04-26 2023-11-02 Illumina, Inc. Machine-learning models for selecting oligonucleotide probes for array technologies
WO2023209606A1 (en) 2022-04-29 2023-11-02 Illumina Cambridge Limited Methods and systems for encapsulating lyophilised microspheres
WO2023220627A1 (en) 2022-05-10 2023-11-16 Illumina Software, Inc. Adaptive neural network for nucelotide sequencing
WO2023224488A1 (en) 2022-05-19 2023-11-23 Agendia N.V. Dna repair signature and prediction of response following cancer therapy
WO2023224487A1 (en) 2022-05-19 2023-11-23 Agendia N.V. Prediction of response to immune therapy in breast cancer patients
WO2023235353A2 (en) 2022-06-03 2023-12-07 Illumina, Inc. Circulating rna biomarkers for preeclampsia
WO2023239917A1 (en) 2022-06-09 2023-12-14 Illumina, Inc. Dependence of base calling on flow cell tilt
WO2023250364A1 (en) 2022-06-21 2023-12-28 Nautilus Subsidiary, Inc. Method for detecting analytes at sites of optically non-resolvable distances
GB202209189D0 (en) 2022-06-22 2022-08-10 Broken String Biosciences Ltd Methods and compositions for nucleic acid sequencing
US20230420080A1 (en) 2022-06-24 2023-12-28 Illumina Software, Inc. Split-read alignment by intelligently identifying and scoring candidate split groups
WO2024006705A1 (en) 2022-06-27 2024-01-04 Illumina Software, Inc. Improved human leukocyte antigen (hla) genotyping
US20230420075A1 (en) 2022-06-27 2023-12-28 Illumina Software, Inc. Accelerators for a genotype imputation model
WO2024006769A1 (en) 2022-06-27 2024-01-04 Illumina Software, Inc. Generating and implementing a structural variation graph genome
WO2024006284A1 (en) * 2022-07-01 2024-01-04 Illumina Cambridge Limited Multiband scanning and fiber bundle to enable reduced light source intensity and improved imaging quality
WO2024015962A1 (en) 2022-07-15 2024-01-18 Pacific Biosciences Of California, Inc. Blocked asymmetric hairpin adaptors
US12010813B2 (en) 2022-07-22 2024-06-11 Manufacturing Resources International, Inc. Self-contained electronic display assembly, mounting structure and methods for the same
US12072561B2 (en) 2022-07-22 2024-08-27 Manufacturing Resources International, Inc. Self-contained electronic display assembly, mounting structure and methods for the same
US12035486B1 (en) 2022-07-25 2024-07-09 Manufacturing Resources International, Inc. Electronic display assembly with fabric panel communications box
US20240038327A1 (en) 2022-07-26 2024-02-01 Illumina Software, Inc. Rapid single-cell multiomics processing using an executable file
US20240033738A1 (en) 2022-07-27 2024-02-01 Illumina, Inc. Flow cell based motion system calibration and control methods
WO2024039516A1 (en) 2022-08-19 2024-02-22 Illumina, Inc. Third dna base pair site-specific dna detection
WO2024059655A1 (en) 2022-09-15 2024-03-21 Nautilus Subsidiary, Inc. Characterizing accessibility of macromolecule structures
WO2024072799A1 (en) 2022-09-26 2024-04-04 Illumina, Inc. Flow cell based motion system calibration and control methods
WO2024073599A1 (en) 2022-09-29 2024-04-04 Nautilus Subsidiary, Inc. Preparation of array surfaces for single-analyte processes
AU2023353465A1 (en) * 2022-09-29 2024-10-03 Illumina, Inc. Dynamic optical system calibration
US20240112753A1 (en) 2022-09-29 2024-04-04 Illumina, Inc. Target-variant-reference panel for imputing target variants
WO2024069581A1 (en) 2022-09-30 2024-04-04 Illumina Singapore Pte. Ltd. Helicase-cytidine deaminase complexes and methods of use
WO2024073047A1 (en) 2022-09-30 2024-04-04 Illumina, Inc. Cytidine deaminases and methods of use in mapping modified cytosine nucleotides
US20240141427A1 (en) 2022-09-30 2024-05-02 Illumina, Inc. Polymerases, compositions, and methods of use
WO2024073043A1 (en) 2022-09-30 2024-04-04 Illumina, Inc. Methods of using cpg binding proteins in mapping modified cytosine nucleotides
US20240120027A1 (en) 2022-09-30 2024-04-11 Illumina, Inc. Machine-learning model for refining structural variant calls
US20240127905A1 (en) 2022-10-05 2024-04-18 Illumina, Inc. Integrating variant calls from multiple sequencing pipelines utilizing a machine learning architecture
WO2024077162A2 (en) 2022-10-06 2024-04-11 Illumina, Inc. Probes for improving coronavirus sample surveillance
WO2024077152A1 (en) 2022-10-06 2024-04-11 Illumina, Inc. Probes for depleting abundant small noncoding rna
WO2024077202A2 (en) 2022-10-06 2024-04-11 Illumina, Inc. Probes for improving environmental sample surveillance
WO2024081649A1 (en) 2022-10-11 2024-04-18 Illumina, Inc. Detecting and correcting methylation values from methylation sequencing assays
WO2024113148A1 (en) * 2022-11-29 2024-06-06 深圳华大智造科技股份有限公司 Fluid system, biochemical analysis and test platform, and fluid operation method
WO2024118903A1 (en) 2022-11-30 2024-06-06 Illumina, Inc. Chemoenzymatic correction of false positive uracil transformations
WO2024118791A1 (en) 2022-11-30 2024-06-06 Illumina, Inc. Accurately predicting variants from methylation sequencing data
WO2024123748A1 (en) 2022-12-07 2024-06-13 Illumina, Inc. Etch-free photoresist patterning in multi-depth nanowells
US20240209429A1 (en) 2022-12-07 2024-06-27 Illumina, Inc. Monoclonal clustering using double stranded dna size exclusion with patterned seeding
US20240192202A1 (en) 2022-12-09 2024-06-13 Nautilus Subsidiary, Inc. Fluidic media for single-analtye arrays
WO2024129672A1 (en) 2022-12-12 2024-06-20 The Broad Institute, Inc. Trafficked rnas for assessment of cell-cell connectivity and neuroanatomy
US20240209419A1 (en) 2022-12-14 2024-06-27 Illumina, Inc. Systems and Methods for Capture and Enrichment of Clustered Beads on Flow Cell Substrates
WO2024130000A1 (en) 2022-12-15 2024-06-20 Nautilus Subsidiary, Inc. Inhibition of photon phenomena on single molecule arrays
WO2024130031A1 (en) 2022-12-16 2024-06-20 Illumina, Inc. Boranes on solid supports
WO2024137774A1 (en) 2022-12-22 2024-06-27 Illumina, Inc. Palladium catalyst compositions and methods for sequencing by synthesis
AU2023409138A1 (en) 2022-12-22 2024-10-03 Illumina, Inc. Transition-metal catalyst compositions and methods for sequencing by synthesis
WO2024145154A1 (en) 2022-12-27 2024-07-04 Illumina, Inc. Methods of sequencing using 3´ allyl blocked nucleotides
WO2024147904A1 (en) 2023-01-06 2024-07-11 Illumina, Inc. Reducing uracils by polymerase
US20240241110A1 (en) 2023-01-12 2024-07-18 Nautilus Subsidiary, Inc. Characterization of glycans and glycoconjugates
WO2024158538A1 (en) 2023-01-27 2024-08-02 Illumina, Inc. Jitter correction image analysis
US20240266003A1 (en) 2023-02-06 2024-08-08 Illumina, Inc. Determining and removing inter-cluster light interference
WO2024173756A1 (en) 2023-02-17 2024-08-22 Illumina, Inc. Cell-free dna signals as biomarkers of preeclampsia
WO2024206122A1 (en) 2023-03-24 2024-10-03 Nautilus Subsidiary, Inc. Improved transfer of nanoparticles to array surfaces
WO2024206848A1 (en) 2023-03-30 2024-10-03 Illumina, Inc. Tandem repeat genotyping
US20240327909A1 (en) 2023-03-30 2024-10-03 Illumina, Inc. Compositions and methods for nucleic acid sequencing

Citations (18)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO1996041011A1 (en) 1995-06-07 1996-12-19 Lynx Therapeutics, Inc. Oligonucleotide tags for sorting and identification
WO1998044151A1 (en) 1997-04-01 1998-10-08 Glaxo Group Limited Method of nucleic acid amplification
WO1998044141A2 (en) 1997-03-27 1998-10-08 The University Of British Columbia Insect expression vectors
WO2000006770A1 (en) 1998-07-30 2000-02-10 Solexa Ltd. Arrayed biomolecules and their use in sequencing
WO2002046456A1 (en) 2000-12-08 2002-06-13 Applied Research Systems Ars Holding N.V. Isothermal amplification of nucleic acids on a solid support
WO2002072892A1 (en) 2001-03-12 2002-09-19 California Institute Of Technology Methods and apparatus for analyzing polynucleotide sequences by asynchronous base extension
WO2003060589A1 (en) 2002-01-15 2003-07-24 Solexa Ltd. Auto focussing device and method
WO2003062897A1 (en) 2002-01-16 2003-07-31 Solexa Ltd. Prism design for optical scanning applications
WO2004018497A2 (en) 2002-08-23 2004-03-04 Solexa Limited Modified nucleotides for polynucleotide sequencing
WO2004018493A1 (en) 2002-08-23 2004-03-04 Solexa Limited Labelled nucleotides
WO2004069849A2 (en) 2003-01-29 2004-08-19 454 Corporation Bead emulsion nucleic acid amplification
WO2005024010A1 (en) 2003-09-11 2005-03-17 Solexa Limited Modified polymerases for improved incorporation of nucleotide analogues
WO2005065814A1 (en) 2004-01-07 2005-07-21 Solexa Limited Modified molecular arrays
WO2005068089A2 (en) 2004-01-16 2005-07-28 Solexa Limited Multiple inexact pattern matching
US7057026B2 (en) 2001-12-04 2006-06-06 Solexa Limited Labelled nucleotides
WO2006064199A1 (en) 2004-12-13 2006-06-22 Solexa Limited Improved method of nucleotide detection
WO2006120433A1 (en) 2005-05-10 2006-11-16 Solexa Limited Improved polymerases
WO2007010251A2 (en) 2005-07-20 2007-01-25 Solexa Limited Preparation of templates for nucleic acid sequencing

Family Cites Families (20)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
JPS58145912A (en) * 1982-02-25 1983-08-31 Nobuhiro Satou Laser light illuminating device
US5846719A (en) 1994-10-13 1998-12-08 Lynx Therapeutics, Inc. Oligonucleotide tags for sorting and identification
WO1998014773A1 (en) * 1996-10-04 1998-04-09 Spectrumedix Corporation Capillary tube holder for electrophoretic applications
US6136543A (en) * 1997-01-31 2000-10-24 Hitachi, Ltd. Method for determining nucleic acids base sequence and apparatus therefor
ES2310514T3 (en) * 1999-03-10 2009-01-16 Asm Scientific, Inc. A METHOD FOR DIRECT SEQUENCING OF NUCLEIC ACID.
EE04249B1 (en) * 1999-04-21 2004-02-16 Asper O� Method for reading biopolymer matrix and fluorescence detector
US6548796B1 (en) * 1999-06-23 2003-04-15 Regents Of The University Of Minnesota Confocal macroscope
GB9923644D0 (en) * 1999-10-06 1999-12-08 Medical Biosystems Ltd DNA sequencing
GB0002389D0 (en) * 2000-02-02 2000-03-22 Solexa Ltd Molecular arrays
US6661937B2 (en) * 2000-06-07 2003-12-09 Corning, Incorporated Fiber squeezing device
FI114399B (en) * 2001-06-06 2004-10-15 Biohit Oyj Method for the determination of extension products
US6744955B2 (en) * 2001-06-29 2004-06-01 Alcatel Buffer tube having a high fiber count ribbon stack packaging configuration and corner cushions
US7122384B2 (en) * 2002-11-06 2006-10-17 E. I. Du Pont De Nemours And Company Resonant light scattering microparticle methods
EP1592810A2 (en) 2003-02-12 2005-11-09 Genizon Svenska AB Methods and means for nucleic acid sequencing
CN103289893B (en) 2003-02-26 2015-11-18 凯利达基因组股份有限公司 By hybridizing the random array DNA analysis carried out
JP4407271B2 (en) * 2003-12-19 2010-02-03 株式会社日立製作所 Chip, reaction analyzer, reaction analysis method
US7276720B2 (en) * 2004-07-19 2007-10-02 Helicos Biosciences Corporation Apparatus and methods for analyzing samples
US20060110756A1 (en) * 2004-10-25 2006-05-25 Tom Tang Large-scale parallelized DNA sequencing
WO2007019479A2 (en) * 2005-08-04 2007-02-15 Helicos Biosciences Corporation Multi-channel flow cells
WO2007038260A2 (en) * 2005-09-23 2007-04-05 Massachusetts Institute Of Technology Systems and methods for force-fluorescence microscopy

Patent Citations (18)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO1996041011A1 (en) 1995-06-07 1996-12-19 Lynx Therapeutics, Inc. Oligonucleotide tags for sorting and identification
WO1998044141A2 (en) 1997-03-27 1998-10-08 The University Of British Columbia Insect expression vectors
WO1998044151A1 (en) 1997-04-01 1998-10-08 Glaxo Group Limited Method of nucleic acid amplification
WO2000006770A1 (en) 1998-07-30 2000-02-10 Solexa Ltd. Arrayed biomolecules and their use in sequencing
WO2002046456A1 (en) 2000-12-08 2002-06-13 Applied Research Systems Ars Holding N.V. Isothermal amplification of nucleic acids on a solid support
WO2002072892A1 (en) 2001-03-12 2002-09-19 California Institute Of Technology Methods and apparatus for analyzing polynucleotide sequences by asynchronous base extension
US7057026B2 (en) 2001-12-04 2006-06-06 Solexa Limited Labelled nucleotides
WO2003060589A1 (en) 2002-01-15 2003-07-24 Solexa Ltd. Auto focussing device and method
WO2003062897A1 (en) 2002-01-16 2003-07-31 Solexa Ltd. Prism design for optical scanning applications
WO2004018497A2 (en) 2002-08-23 2004-03-04 Solexa Limited Modified nucleotides for polynucleotide sequencing
WO2004018493A1 (en) 2002-08-23 2004-03-04 Solexa Limited Labelled nucleotides
WO2004069849A2 (en) 2003-01-29 2004-08-19 454 Corporation Bead emulsion nucleic acid amplification
WO2005024010A1 (en) 2003-09-11 2005-03-17 Solexa Limited Modified polymerases for improved incorporation of nucleotide analogues
WO2005065814A1 (en) 2004-01-07 2005-07-21 Solexa Limited Modified molecular arrays
WO2005068089A2 (en) 2004-01-16 2005-07-28 Solexa Limited Multiple inexact pattern matching
WO2006064199A1 (en) 2004-12-13 2006-06-22 Solexa Limited Improved method of nucleotide detection
WO2006120433A1 (en) 2005-05-10 2006-11-16 Solexa Limited Improved polymerases
WO2007010251A2 (en) 2005-07-20 2007-01-25 Solexa Limited Preparation of templates for nucleic acid sequencing

Non-Patent Citations (5)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Title
IEEE TRANS. SYSTEMS, MAN, AND CYBERNETICS, vol. 9, 1979, pages 62 - 66
NAT BIOTECHNOL., vol. 6, 2000, pages 630 - 6344
NATURE, vol. 437, 2005, pages 376 - 380
PROCEEDINGS OF THE NATIONAL ACADEMY OF SCIENCES U.S.A, vol. 100, 2003, pages 3960 - 3964
SCIENCE, vol. 309, no. 5741, 2005, pages 1728 - 1732

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
ES2675047T3 (en) 2018-07-06
WO2007123744A2 (en) 2007-11-01
JP5122555B2 (en) 2013-01-16
EP2018622B1 (en) 2018-04-25
EP2018622A2 (en) 2009-01-28
EP3722409A1 (en) 2020-10-14
US8241573B2 (en) 2012-08-14
EP2018622A4 (en) 2013-03-20
CN101460953B (en) 2012-05-30
JP2009532031A (en) 2009-09-10
EP4105644A3 (en) 2022-12-28
SG170802A1 (en) 2011-05-30
US20100111768A1 (en) 2010-05-06
EP3373174A1 (en) 2018-09-12
CN101460953A (en) 2009-06-17
CA2648149A1 (en) 2007-11-01
WO2007123744A3 (en) 2008-11-27

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
EP2018622B1 (en) Systems for sequence by synthesis analysis
US10017815B2 (en) Method for high throughput screening of nucleic acids
TWI689719B (en) Methods for detecting optical signals from samples
EP2531880B1 (en) Focusing methods and optical systems and assemblies using the same
CN115287341A (en) High performance fluorescence imaging module for genomic testing assays
US20170022558A1 (en) Integrated system for nucleic acid sequence and analysis
JP2024501232A (en) System and method for multicolor imaging
KR20240063107A (en) Optical systems and methods for nucleic acid sequencing
US20140038274A1 (en) Nucleic acid analysis device, nucleic acid analysis apparatus, and nucleic acid analysis method
JP5171668B2 (en) Method for correcting substrate misalignment
CN217981206U (en) Imaging system, detection device and nucleic acid molecule sequencing system
EP4345444A1 (en) Dynamic optical system calibration
WO2024163782A1 (en) Robust flow cell design for spatial transcriptomics and in situ hybridization that operates under high pressure with increased flow rates and improved flow dynamics
WO2024118641A1 (en) Flow cell devices and optical systems for nucleic acid sequencing
CN118879841A (en) Optical system for nucleic acid sequencing

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
PUAI Public reference made under article 153(3) epc to a published international application that has entered the european phase

Free format text: ORIGINAL CODE: 0009012

STAA Information on the status of an ep patent application or granted ep patent

Free format text: STATUS: REQUEST FOR EXAMINATION WAS MADE

PUAL Search report despatched

Free format text: ORIGINAL CODE: 0009013

17P Request for examination filed

Effective date: 20220602

AC Divisional application: reference to earlier application

Ref document number: 2018622

Country of ref document: EP

Kind code of ref document: P

Ref document number: 3373174

Country of ref document: EP

Kind code of ref document: P

Ref document number: 3722409

Country of ref document: EP

Kind code of ref document: P

AK Designated contracting states

Kind code of ref document: A2

Designated state(s): AT BE BG CH CY CZ DE DK EE ES FI FR GB GR HU IE IS IT LI LT LU LV MC MT NL PL PT RO SE SI SK TR

AK Designated contracting states

Kind code of ref document: A3

Designated state(s): AT BE BG CH CY CZ DE DK EE ES FI FR GB GR HU IE IS IT LI LT LU LV MC MT NL PL PT RO SE SI SK TR

RIC1 Information provided on ipc code assigned before grant

Ipc: B01L 3/00 20060101ALI20221121BHEP

Ipc: B01L 9/00 20060101ALI20221121BHEP

Ipc: C12Q 1/68 20180101ALI20221121BHEP

Ipc: G01N 21/64 20060101AFI20221121BHEP